xref: /linux/include/uapi/linux/nl80211.h (revision 1a9239bb4253f9076b5b4b2a1a4e8d7defd77a95)
1 #ifndef __LINUX_NL80211_H
2 #define __LINUX_NL80211_H
3 /*
4  * 802.11 netlink interface public header
5  *
6  * Copyright 2006-2010 Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
7  * Copyright 2008 Michael Wu <flamingice@sourmilk.net>
8  * Copyright 2008 Luis Carlos Cobo <luisca@cozybit.com>
9  * Copyright 2008 Michael Buesch <m@bues.ch>
10  * Copyright 2008, 2009 Luis R. Rodriguez <lrodriguez@atheros.com>
11  * Copyright 2008 Jouni Malinen <jouni.malinen@atheros.com>
12  * Copyright 2008 Colin McCabe <colin@cozybit.com>
13  * Copyright 2015-2017	Intel Deutschland GmbH
14  * Copyright (C) 2018-2025 Intel Corporation
15  *
16  * Permission to use, copy, modify, and/or distribute this software for any
17  * purpose with or without fee is hereby granted, provided that the above
18  * copyright notice and this permission notice appear in all copies.
19  *
20  * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS" AND THE AUTHOR DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES
21  * WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
22  * MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR
23  * ANY SPECIAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
24  * WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN AN
25  * ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING OUT OF
26  * OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
27  *
28  */
29 
30 /*
31  * This header file defines the userspace API to the wireless stack. Please
32  * be careful not to break things - i.e. don't move anything around or so
33  * unless you can demonstrate that it breaks neither API nor ABI.
34  *
35  * Additions to the API should be accompanied by actual implementations in
36  * an upstream driver, so that example implementations exist in case there
37  * are ever concerns about the precise semantics of the API or changes are
38  * needed, and to ensure that code for dead (no longer implemented) API
39  * can actually be identified and removed.
40  * Nonetheless, semantics should also be documented carefully in this file.
41  */
42 
43 #include <linux/types.h>
44 
45 #define NL80211_GENL_NAME "nl80211"
46 
47 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_CONFIG		"config"
48 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_SCAN		"scan"
49 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_REG		"regulatory"
50 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_MLME		"mlme"
51 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_VENDOR		"vendor"
52 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_NAN		"nan"
53 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_TESTMODE	"testmode"
54 
55 #define NL80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_MIN	4
56 #define NL80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_MAX	15
57 #define NL80211_EDMG_CHANNELS_MIN	1
58 #define NL80211_EDMG_CHANNELS_MAX	0x3c /* 0b00111100 */
59 
60 /**
61  * DOC: Station handling
62  *
63  * Stations are added per interface, but a special case exists with VLAN
64  * interfaces. When a station is bound to an AP interface, it may be moved
65  * into a VLAN identified by a VLAN interface index (%NL80211_ATTR_STA_VLAN).
66  * The station is still assumed to belong to the AP interface it was added
67  * to.
68  *
69  * Station handling varies per interface type and depending on the driver's
70  * capabilities.
71  *
72  * For drivers supporting TDLS with external setup (WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS
73  * and WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP), the station lifetime is as follows:
74  *  - a setup station entry is added, not yet authorized, without any rate
75  *    or capability information; this just exists to avoid race conditions
76  *  - when the TDLS setup is done, a single NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION is valid
77  *    to add rate and capability information to the station and at the same
78  *    time mark it authorized.
79  *  - %NL80211_TDLS_ENABLE_LINK is then used
80  *  - after this, the only valid operation is to remove it by tearing down
81  *    the TDLS link (%NL80211_TDLS_DISABLE_LINK)
82  *
83  * TODO: need more info for other interface types
84  */
85 
86 /**
87  * DOC: Frame transmission/registration support
88  *
89  * Frame transmission and registration support exists to allow userspace
90  * management entities such as wpa_supplicant to react to management frames
91  * that are not being handled by the kernel. This includes, for example,
92  * certain classes of action frames that cannot be handled in the kernel
93  * for various reasons.
94  *
95  * Frame registration is done on a per-interface basis and registrations
96  * cannot be removed other than by closing the socket. It is possible to
97  * specify a registration filter to register, for example, only for a
98  * certain type of action frame. In particular with action frames, those
99  * that userspace registers for will not be returned as unhandled by the
100  * driver, so that the registered application has to take responsibility
101  * for doing that.
102  *
103  * The type of frame that can be registered for is also dependent on the
104  * driver and interface type. The frame types are advertised in wiphy
105  * attributes so applications know what to expect.
106  *
107  * NOTE: When an interface changes type while registrations are active,
108  *       these registrations are ignored until the interface type is
109  *       changed again. This means that changing the interface type can
110  *       lead to a situation that couldn't otherwise be produced, but
111  *       any such registrations will be dormant in the sense that they
112  *       will not be serviced, i.e. they will not receive any frames.
113  *
114  * Frame transmission allows userspace to send for example the required
115  * responses to action frames. It is subject to some sanity checking,
116  * but many frames can be transmitted. When a frame is transmitted, its
117  * status is indicated to the sending socket.
118  *
119  * For more technical details, see the corresponding command descriptions
120  * below.
121  */
122 
123 /**
124  * DOC: Virtual interface / concurrency capabilities
125  *
126  * Some devices are able to operate with virtual MACs; they can have
127  * more than one virtual interface. The capability handling for this
128  * is a bit complex though, as there may be a number of restrictions
129  * on the types of concurrency that are supported.
130  *
131  * To start with, each device supports the interface types listed in
132  * the %NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES attribute, but by listing the
133  * types there no concurrency is implied.
134  *
135  * Once concurrency is desired, more attributes must be observed:
136  * To start with, since some interface types are purely managed in
137  * software, like the AP-VLAN type in mac80211 for example, there's
138  * an additional list of these; they can be added at any time and
139  * are only restricted by some semantic restrictions (e.g. AP-VLAN
140  * cannot be added without a corresponding AP interface). This list
141  * is exported in the %NL80211_ATTR_SOFTWARE_IFTYPES attribute.
142  *
143  * Further, the list of supported combinations is exported. This is
144  * in the %NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS attribute. Basically,
145  * it exports a list of "groups", and at any point in time the
146  * interfaces that are currently active must fall into any one of
147  * the advertised groups. Within each group, there are restrictions
148  * on the number of interfaces of different types that are supported
149  * and also the number of different channels, along with potentially
150  * some other restrictions. See &enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs.
151  *
152  * All together, these attributes define the concurrency of virtual
153  * interfaces that a given device supports.
154  */
155 
156 /**
157  * DOC: packet coalesce support
158  *
159  * In most cases, host that receives IPv4 and IPv6 multicast/broadcast
160  * packets does not do anything with these packets. Therefore the
161  * reception of these unwanted packets causes unnecessary processing
162  * and power consumption.
163  *
164  * Packet coalesce feature helps to reduce number of received interrupts
165  * to host by buffering these packets in firmware/hardware for some
166  * predefined time. Received interrupt will be generated when one of the
167  * following events occurs.
168  * a) Expiration of hardware timer whose expiration time is set to maximum
169  * coalescing delay of matching coalesce rule.
170  * b) Coalescing buffer in hardware reaches its limit.
171  * c) Packet doesn't match any of the configured coalesce rules.
172  *
173  * User needs to configure following parameters for creating a coalesce
174  * rule.
175  * a) Maximum coalescing delay
176  * b) List of packet patterns which needs to be matched
177  * c) Condition for coalescence: pattern 'match' or 'no match'
178  * Multiple such rules can be created.
179  */
180 
181 /**
182  * DOC: WPA/WPA2 EAPOL handshake offload
183  *
184  * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_PSK flag drivers
185  * can indicate they support offloading EAPOL handshakes for WPA/WPA2
186  * preshared key authentication in station mode. In %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT
187  * the preshared key should be specified using %NL80211_ATTR_PMK. Drivers
188  * supporting this offload may reject the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT when no
189  * preshared key material is provided, for example when that driver does
190  * not support setting the temporal keys through %NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY.
191  *
192  * Similarly @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_1X flag can be
193  * set by drivers indicating offload support of the PTK/GTK EAPOL
194  * handshakes during 802.1X authentication in station mode. In order to
195  * use the offload the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT should have
196  * %NL80211_ATTR_WANT_1X_4WAY_HS attribute flag. Drivers supporting this
197  * offload may reject the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT when the attribute flag is
198  * not present.
199  *
200  * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_AP_PSK flag drivers
201  * can indicate they support offloading EAPOL handshakes for WPA/WPA2
202  * preshared key authentication in AP mode. In %NL80211_CMD_START_AP
203  * the preshared key should be specified using %NL80211_ATTR_PMK. Drivers
204  * supporting this offload may reject the %NL80211_CMD_START_AP when no
205  * preshared key material is provided, for example when that driver does
206  * not support setting the temporal keys through %NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY.
207  *
208  * For 802.1X the PMK or PMK-R0 are set by providing %NL80211_ATTR_PMK
209  * using %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK. For offloaded FT support also
210  * %NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME must be provided.
211  */
212 
213 /**
214  * DOC: FILS shared key authentication offload
215  *
216  * FILS shared key authentication offload can be advertised by drivers by
217  * setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_SK_OFFLOAD flag. The drivers that support
218  * FILS shared key authentication offload should be able to construct the
219  * authentication and association frames for FILS shared key authentication and
220  * eventually do a key derivation as per IEEE 802.11ai. The below additional
221  * parameters should be given to driver in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and/or in
222  * %NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_CONNECT_PARAMS.
223  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME - used to construct keyname_nai
224  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM - used to construct keyname_nai
225  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM - used to construct erp message
226  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_RRK - used to generate the rIK and rMSK
227  * rIK should be used to generate an authentication tag on the ERP message and
228  * rMSK should be used to derive a PMKSA.
229  * rIK, rMSK should be generated and keyname_nai, sequence number should be used
230  * as specified in IETF RFC 6696.
231  *
232  * When FILS shared key authentication is completed, driver needs to provide the
233  * below additional parameters to userspace, which can be either after setting
234  * up a connection or after roaming.
235  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK - used for key renewal
236  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM - used in further EAP-RP exchanges
237  *	%NL80211_ATTR_PMKID - used to identify the PMKSA used/generated
238  *	%Nl80211_ATTR_PMK - used to update PMKSA cache in userspace
239  * The PMKSA can be maintained in userspace persistently so that it can be used
240  * later after reboots or wifi turn off/on also.
241  *
242  * %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID is the cache identifier advertised by a FILS
243  * capable AP supporting PMK caching. It specifies the scope within which the
244  * PMKSAs are cached in an ESS. %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA and
245  * %NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA are enhanced to allow support for PMKSA caching based
246  * on FILS cache identifier. Additionally %NL80211_ATTR_PMK is used with
247  * %NL80211_SET_PMKSA to specify the PMK corresponding to a PMKSA for driver to
248  * use in a FILS shared key connection with PMKSA caching.
249  */
250 
251 /**
252  * DOC: SAE authentication offload
253  *
254  * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD flag drivers can indicate they
255  * support offloading SAE authentication for WPA3-Personal networks in station
256  * mode. Similarly @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD_AP flag can be set by
257  * drivers indicating the offload support in AP mode.
258  *
259  * The password for SAE should be specified using %NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PASSWORD in
260  * %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and %NL80211_CMD_START_AP for station and AP mode
261  * respectively.
262  */
263 
264 /**
265  * DOC: VLAN offload support for setting group keys and binding STAs to VLANs
266  *
267  * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VLAN_OFFLOAD flag drivers can indicate they
268  * support offloading VLAN functionality in a manner where the driver exposes a
269  * single netdev that uses VLAN tagged frames and separate VLAN-specific netdevs
270  * can then be added using RTM_NEWLINK/IFLA_VLAN_ID similarly to the Ethernet
271  * case. Frames received from stations that are not assigned to any VLAN are
272  * delivered on the main netdev and frames to such stations can be sent through
273  * that main netdev.
274  *
275  * %NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY (for group keys), %NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION, and
276  * %NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION will optionally specify vlan_id using
277  * %NL80211_ATTR_VLAN_ID.
278  */
279 
280 /**
281  * DOC: TID configuration
282  *
283  * TID config support can be checked in the %NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG
284  * attribute given in wiphy capabilities.
285  *
286  * The necessary configuration parameters are mentioned in
287  * &enum nl80211_tid_config_attr and it will be passed to the
288  * %NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG command in %NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG.
289  *
290  * If the configuration needs to be applied for specific peer then the MAC
291  * address of the peer needs to be passed in %NL80211_ATTR_MAC, otherwise the
292  * configuration will be applied for all the connected peers in the vif except
293  * any peers that have peer-specific configuration for the TID by default; if
294  * the %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE flag is set, peer-specific values
295  * will be overwritten.
296  *
297  * All this configuration is valid only for STA's current connection,
298  * i.e., the configuration will be reset to default when the STA connects back
299  * after disconnection/roaming, and this configuration will be cleared when
300  * the interface goes down.
301  */
302 
303 /**
304  * DOC: FILS shared key crypto offload
305  *
306  * This feature is applicable to drivers running in AP mode.
307  *
308  * FILS shared key crypto offload can be advertised by drivers by setting
309  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_CRYPTO_OFFLOAD flag. The drivers that support
310  * FILS shared key crypto offload should be able to encrypt and decrypt
311  * association frames for FILS shared key authentication as per IEEE 802.11ai.
312  * With this capability, for FILS key derivation, drivers depend on userspace.
313  *
314  * After FILS key derivation, userspace shares the FILS AAD details with the
315  * driver and the driver stores the same to use in decryption of association
316  * request and in encryption of association response. The below parameters
317  * should be given to the driver in %NL80211_CMD_SET_FILS_AAD.
318  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC - STA MAC address, used for storing FILS AAD per STA
319  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK - Used for encryption or decryption
320  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES - Used for encryption or decryption
321  *			(STA Nonce 16 bytes followed by AP Nonce 16 bytes)
322  *
323  * Once the association is done, the driver cleans the FILS AAD data.
324  */
325 
326 /**
327  * DOC: Multi-Link Operation
328  *
329  * In Multi-Link Operation, a connection between two MLDs utilizes multiple
330  * links. To use this in nl80211, various commands and responses now need
331  * to or will include the new %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINKS attribute.
332  * Additionally, various commands that need to operate on a specific link
333  * now need to be given the %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID attribute, e.g. to
334  * use %NL80211_CMD_START_AP or similar functions.
335  */
336 
337 /**
338  * DOC: OWE DH IE handling offload
339  *
340  * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OWE_OFFLOAD flag, drivers can indicate
341  * kernel/application space to avoid DH IE handling. When this flag is
342  * advertised, the driver/device will take care of DH IE inclusion and
343  * processing of peer DH IE to generate PMK.
344  */
345 
346 /**
347  * enum nl80211_commands - supported nl80211 commands
348  *
349  * @NL80211_CMD_UNSPEC: unspecified command to catch errors
350  *
351  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY: request information about a wiphy or dump request
352  *	to get a list of all present wiphys.
353  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY: set wiphy parameters, needs %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY or
354  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX; can be used to set %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME,
355  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS, %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ,
356  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET (and the attributes determining the
357  *	channel width; this is used for setting monitor mode channel),
358  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_SHORT, %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_LONG,
359  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FRAG_THRESHOLD, and/or
360  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RTS_THRESHOLD.  However, for setting the channel,
361  *	see %NL80211_CMD_SET_CHANNEL instead, the support here is for backward
362  *	compatibility only.
363  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_WIPHY: Newly created wiphy, response to get request
364  *	or rename notification. Has attributes %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY and
365  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME.
366  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_WIPHY: Wiphy deleted. Has attributes
367  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME.
368  *
369  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_INTERFACE: Request an interface's configuration;
370  *	either a dump request for all interfaces or a specific get with a
371  *	single %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is supported.
372  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_INTERFACE: Set type of a virtual interface, requires
373  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE.
374  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE: Newly created virtual interface or response
375  *	to %NL80211_CMD_GET_INTERFACE. Has %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX,
376  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY and %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE attributes. Can also
377  *	be sent from userspace to request creation of a new virtual interface,
378  *	then requires attributes %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY, %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE and
379  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFNAME.
380  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_INTERFACE: Virtual interface was deleted, has attributes
381  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY. Can also be sent from
382  *	userspace to request deletion of a virtual interface, then requires
383  *	attribute %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. If multiple BSSID advertisements are
384  *	enabled using %NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_CONFIG, %NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_ELEMS,
385  *	and if this command is used for the transmitting interface, then all
386  *	the non-transmitting interfaces are deleted as well.
387  *
388  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_KEY: Get sequence counter information for a key specified
389  *	by %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX and/or %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
390  *	represents peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key. For MLO group key,
391  *	the link is identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID.
392  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_KEY: Set key attributes %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT,
393  *	%NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT, or %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_THRESHOLD.
394  *	For MLO connection, the link to set default key is identified by
395  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID.
396  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY: add a key with given %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DATA,
397  *	%NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC, %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_CIPHER,
398  *	and %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ attributes. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC represents
399  *	peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key. The link to add MLO
400  *	group key is identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID.
401  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_KEY: delete a key identified by %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX
402  *	or %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC represents peer's MLD address
403  *	for MLO pairwise key. The link to delete group key is identified by
404  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID.
405  *
406  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_BEACON: (not used)
407  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON: change the beacon on an access point interface
408  *	using the %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_HEAD and %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL
409  *	attributes. For drivers that generate the beacon and probe responses
410  *	internally, the following attributes must be provided: %NL80211_ATTR_IE,
411  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IE_PROBE_RESP and %NL80211_ATTR_IE_ASSOC_RESP.
412  * @NL80211_CMD_START_AP: Start AP operation on an AP interface, parameters
413  *	are like for %NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON, and additionally parameters that
414  *	do not change are used, these include %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL,
415  *	%NL80211_ATTR_DTIM_PERIOD, %NL80211_ATTR_SSID,
416  *	%NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID, %NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE,
417  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP, %NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS,
418  *	%NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES, %NL80211_ATTR_PRIVACY,
419  *	%NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE, %NL80211_ATTR_INACTIVITY_TIMEOUT,
420  *	%NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS.
421  *	The channel to use can be set on the interface or be given using the
422  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET, and the
423  *	attributes determining channel width.
424  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON: old alias for %NL80211_CMD_START_AP
425  * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP: Stop AP operation on the given interface
426  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_BEACON: old alias for %NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP
427  *
428  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_STATION: Get station attributes for station identified by
429  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
430  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION: Set station attributes for station identified by
431  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
432  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION: Add a station with given attributes to the
433  *	interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
434  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_STATION: Remove a station identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
435  *	or, if no MAC address given, all stations, on the interface identified
436  *	by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. For MLD station, MLD address is used in
437  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC. %NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE and
438  *	%NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE can optionally be used to specify which type
439  *	of disconnection indication should be sent to the station
440  *	(Deauthentication or Disassociation frame and reason code for that
441  *	frame). %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID can be used optionally to remove
442  *	stations connected and using at least that link as one of its links.
443  *
444  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_MPATH: Get mesh path attributes for mesh path to
445  *	destination %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by
446  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
447  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MPATH:  Set mesh path attributes for mesh path to
448  *	destination %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by
449  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
450  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_MPATH: Create a new mesh path for the destination given by
451  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC via %NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_NEXT_HOP.
452  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_MPATH: Delete a mesh path to the destination given by
453  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC.
454  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS: Set BSS attributes for BSS identified by
455  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
456  *
457  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_REG: ask the wireless core to send us its currently set
458  *	regulatory domain. If %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY is specified and the device
459  *	has a private regulatory domain, it will be returned. Otherwise, the
460  *	global regdomain will be returned.
461  *	A device will have a private regulatory domain if it uses the
462  *	regulatory_hint() API. Even when a private regdomain is used the channel
463  *	information will still be mended according to further hints from
464  *	the regulatory core to help with compliance. A dump version of this API
465  *	is now available which will returns the global regdomain as well as
466  *	all private regdomains of present wiphys (for those that have it).
467  *	If a wiphy is self-managed (%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED_REG), then
468  *	its private regdomain is the only valid one for it. The regulatory
469  *	core is not used to help with compliance in this case.
470  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_REG: Set current regulatory domain. CRDA sends this command
471  *	after being queried by the kernel. CRDA replies by sending a regulatory
472  *	domain structure which consists of %NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA set to our
473  *	current alpha2 if it found a match. It also provides
474  *	NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FLAGS, and a set of regulatory rules. Each
475  *	regulatory rule is a nested set of attributes  given by
476  *	%NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FREQ_[START|END] and
477  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_MAX_BW with an attached power rule given by
478  *	%NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_POWER_MAX_ANT_GAIN and
479  *	%NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_POWER_MAX_EIRP.
480  * @NL80211_CMD_REQ_SET_REG: ask the wireless core to set the regulatory domain
481  *	to the specified ISO/IEC 3166-1 alpha2 country code. The core will
482  *	store this as a valid request and then query userspace for it.
483  *
484  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_CONFIG: Get mesh networking properties for the
485  *	interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX
486  *
487  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_CONFIG: Set mesh networking properties for the
488  *      interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX
489  *
490  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE: Set extra IEs for management frames. The
491  *	interface is identified with %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and the management
492  *	frame subtype with %NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE. The extra IE data to be
493  *	added to the end of the specified management frame is specified with
494  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IE. If the command succeeds, the requested data will be
495  *	added to all specified management frames generated by
496  *	kernel/firmware/driver.
497  *	Note: This command has been removed and it is only reserved at this
498  *	point to avoid re-using existing command number. The functionality this
499  *	command was planned for has been provided with cleaner design with the
500  *	option to specify additional IEs in NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN,
501  *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE, NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE,
502  *	NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE, and NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE.
503  *
504  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN: get scan results
505  * @NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN: trigger a new scan with the given parameters
506  *	%NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE is used to decide whether to send the
507  *	probe requests at CCK rate or not. %NL80211_ATTR_BSSID can be used to
508  *	specify a BSSID to scan for; if not included, the wildcard BSSID will
509  *	be used.
510  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_SCAN_RESULTS: scan notification (as a reply to
511  *	NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN and on the "scan" multicast group)
512  * @NL80211_CMD_SCAN_ABORTED: scan was aborted, for unspecified reasons,
513  *	partial scan results may be available
514  *
515  * @NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN: start a scheduled scan at certain
516  *	intervals and certain number of cycles, as specified by
517  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS. If %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS is
518  *	not specified and only %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL is specified,
519  *	scheduled scan will run in an infinite loop with the specified interval.
520  *	These attributes are mutually exclusive,
521  *	i.e. NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL must not be passed if
522  *	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS is defined.
523  *	If for some reason scheduled scan is aborted by the driver, all scan
524  *	plans are canceled (including scan plans that did not start yet).
525  *	Like with normal scans, if SSIDs (%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS)
526  *	are passed, they are used in the probe requests.  For
527  *	broadcast, a broadcast SSID must be passed (ie. an empty
528  *	string).  If no SSID is passed, no probe requests are sent and
529  *	a passive scan is performed.  %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES,
530  *	if passed, define which channels should be scanned; if not
531  *	passed, all channels allowed for the current regulatory domain
532  *	are used.  Extra IEs can also be passed from the userspace by
533  *	using the %NL80211_ATTR_IE attribute.  The first cycle of the
534  *	scheduled scan can be delayed by %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_DELAY
535  *	is supplied. If the device supports multiple concurrent scheduled
536  *	scans, it will allow such when the caller provides the flag attribute
537  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MULTI to indicate user-space support for it.
538  * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_SCHED_SCAN: stop a scheduled scan. Returns -ENOENT if
539  *	scheduled scan is not running. The caller may assume that as soon
540  *	as the call returns, it is safe to start a new scheduled scan again.
541  * @NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_RESULTS: indicates that there are scheduled scan
542  *	results available.
543  * @NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_STOPPED: indicates that the scheduled scan has
544  *	stopped.  The driver may issue this event at any time during a
545  *	scheduled scan.  One reason for stopping the scan is if the hardware
546  *	does not support starting an association or a normal scan while running
547  *	a scheduled scan.  This event is also sent when the
548  *	%NL80211_CMD_STOP_SCHED_SCAN command is received or when the interface
549  *	is brought down while a scheduled scan was running.
550  *
551  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY: get survey results, e.g. channel occupation
552  *      or noise level
553  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_SURVEY_RESULTS: survey data notification (as a reply to
554  *	NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY and on the "scan" multicast group)
555  *
556  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA: Add a PMKSA cache entry using %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
557  *	(for the BSSID), %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID, and optionally %NL80211_ATTR_PMK
558  *	(PMK is used for PTKSA derivation in case of FILS shared key offload) or
559  *	using %NL80211_ATTR_SSID, %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID,
560  *	%NL80211_ATTR_PMKID, and %NL80211_ATTR_PMK in case of FILS
561  *	authentication where %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID is the identifier
562  *	advertised by a FILS capable AP identifying the scope of PMKSA in an
563  *	ESS.
564  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA: Delete a PMKSA cache entry, using %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
565  *	(for the BSSID) and %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID or using %NL80211_ATTR_SSID,
566  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID, and %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID in case of FILS
567  *	authentication. Additionally in case of SAE offload and OWE offloads
568  *	PMKSA entry can be deleted using %NL80211_ATTR_SSID.
569  * @NL80211_CMD_FLUSH_PMKSA: Flush all PMKSA cache entries.
570  *
571  * @NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE: indicates to userspace the regulatory domain
572  *	has been changed and provides details of the request information
573  *	that caused the change such as who initiated the regulatory request
574  *	(%NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR), the wiphy_idx
575  *	(%NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2) on which the request was made from if
576  *	the initiator was %NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_COUNTRY_IE or
577  *	%NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER, the type of regulatory domain
578  *	set (%NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE), if the type of regulatory domain is
579  *	%NL80211_REG_TYPE_COUNTRY the alpha2 to which we have moved on
580  *	to (%NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2).
581  * @NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT: indicates to userspace that an AP beacon
582  *	has been found while world roaming thus enabling active scan or
583  *	any mode of operation that initiates TX (beacons) on a channel
584  *	where we would not have been able to do either before. As an example
585  *	if you are world roaming (regulatory domain set to world or if your
586  *	driver is using a custom world roaming regulatory domain) and while
587  *	doing a passive scan on the 5 GHz band you find an AP there (if not
588  *	on a DFS channel) you will now be able to actively scan for that AP
589  *	or use AP mode on your card on that same channel. Note that this will
590  *	never be used for channels 1-11 on the 2 GHz band as they are always
591  *	enabled world wide. This beacon hint is only sent if your device had
592  *	either disabled active scanning or beaconing on a channel. We send to
593  *	userspace the wiphy on which we removed a restriction from
594  *	(%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY) and the channel on which this occurred
595  *	before (%NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_BEFORE) and after (%NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_AFTER)
596  *	the beacon hint was processed.
597  *
598  * @NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE: authentication request and notification.
599  *	This command is used both as a command (request to authenticate) and
600  *	as an event on the "mlme" multicast group indicating completion of the
601  *	authentication process.
602  *	When used as a command, %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to identify the
603  *	interface. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC is used to specify PeerSTAAddress (and
604  *	BSSID in case of station mode). %NL80211_ATTR_SSID is used to specify
605  *	the SSID (mainly for association, but is included in authentication
606  *	request, too, to help BSS selection. %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ +
607  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET is used to specify the frequency of the
608  *	channel in MHz. %NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE is used to specify the
609  *	authentication type. %NL80211_ATTR_IE is used to define IEs
610  *	(VendorSpecificInfo, but also including RSN IE and FT IEs) to be added
611  *	to the frame.
612  *	When used as an event, this reports reception of an Authentication
613  *	frame in station and IBSS modes when the local MLME processed the
614  *	frame, i.e., it was for the local STA and was received in correct
615  *	state. This is similar to MLME-AUTHENTICATE.confirm primitive in the
616  *	MLME SAP interface (kernel providing MLME, userspace SME). The
617  *	included %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME attribute contains the management frame
618  *	(including both the header and frame body, but not FCS). This event is
619  *	also used to indicate if the authentication attempt timed out. In that
620  *	case the %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME attribute is replaced with a
621  *	%NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT flag (and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC to indicate which
622  *	pending authentication timed out).
623  * @NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE: association request and notification; like
624  *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE but for Association and Reassociation
625  *	(similar to MLME-ASSOCIATE.request, MLME-REASSOCIATE.request,
626  *	MLME-ASSOCIATE.confirm or MLME-REASSOCIATE.confirm primitives). The
627  *	%NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID attribute is used to specify whether the
628  *	request is for the initial association to an ESS (that attribute not
629  *	included) or for reassociation within the ESS (that attribute is
630  *	included).
631  * @NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE: deauthentication request and notification; like
632  *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE but for Deauthentication frames (similar to
633  *	MLME-DEAUTHENTICATION.request and MLME-DEAUTHENTICATE.indication
634  *	primitives).
635  * @NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE: disassociation request and notification; like
636  *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE but for Disassociation frames (similar to
637  *	MLME-DISASSOCIATE.request and MLME-DISASSOCIATE.indication primitives).
638  *
639  * @NL80211_CMD_MICHAEL_MIC_FAILURE: notification of a locally detected Michael
640  *	MIC (part of TKIP) failure; sent on the "mlme" multicast group; the
641  *	event includes %NL80211_ATTR_MAC to describe the source MAC address of
642  *	the frame with invalid MIC, %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_TYPE to show the key
643  *	type, %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX to indicate the key identifier, and
644  *	%NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ to indicate the TSC value of the frame; this
645  *	event matches with MLME-MICHAELMICFAILURE.indication() primitive
646  *
647  * @NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS: Join a new IBSS -- given at least an SSID and a
648  *	FREQ attribute (for the initial frequency if no peer can be found)
649  *	and optionally a MAC (as BSSID) and FREQ_FIXED attribute if those
650  *	should be fixed rather than automatically determined. Can only be
651  *	executed on a network interface that is UP, and fixed BSSID/FREQ
652  *	may be rejected. Another optional parameter is the beacon interval,
653  *	given in the %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL attribute, which if not
654  *	given defaults to 100 TU (102.4ms).
655  * @NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_IBSS: Leave the IBSS -- no special arguments, the IBSS is
656  *	determined by the network interface.
657  *
658  * @NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE: testmode command, takes a wiphy (or ifindex) attribute
659  *	to identify the device, and the TESTDATA blob attribute to pass through
660  *	to the driver.
661  *
662  * @NL80211_CMD_CONNECT: connection request and notification; this command
663  *	requests to connect to a specified network but without separating
664  *	auth and assoc steps. For this, you need to specify the SSID in a
665  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SSID attribute, and can optionally specify the association
666  *	IEs in %NL80211_ATTR_IE, %NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE,
667  *	%NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC, %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ,
668  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET, %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT,
669  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE,
670  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT,
671  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT, and
672  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT.
673  *	If included, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ are
674  *	restrictions on BSS selection, i.e., they effectively prevent roaming
675  *	within the ESS. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT
676  *	can be included to provide a recommendation of the initial BSS while
677  *	allowing the driver to roam to other BSSes within the ESS and also to
678  *	ignore this recommendation if the indicated BSS is not ideal. Only one
679  *	set of BSSID,frequency parameters is used (i.e., either the enforcing
680  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC,%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ or the less strict
681  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT).
682  *	Driver shall not modify the IEs specified through %NL80211_ATTR_IE if
683  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC is included. However, if %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT is
684  *	included, these IEs through %NL80211_ATTR_IE are specified by the user
685  *	space based on the best possible BSS selected. Thus, if the driver ends
686  *	up selecting a different BSS, it can modify these IEs accordingly (e.g.
687  *	userspace asks the driver to perform PMKSA caching with BSS1 and the
688  *	driver ends up selecting BSS2 with different PMKSA cache entry; RSNIE
689  *	has to get updated with the apt PMKID).
690  *	%NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID can be used to request a reassociation within
691  *	the ESS in case the device is already associated and an association with
692  *	a different BSS is desired.
693  *	Background scan period can optionally be
694  *	specified in %NL80211_ATTR_BG_SCAN_PERIOD,
695  *	if not specified default background scan configuration
696  *	in driver is used and if period value is 0, bg scan will be disabled.
697  *	This attribute is ignored if driver does not support roam scan.
698  *	It is also sent as an event, with the BSSID and response IEs when the
699  *	connection is established or failed to be established. This can be
700  *	determined by the %NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE attribute (0 = success,
701  *	non-zero = failure). If %NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT is included in the
702  *	event, the connection attempt failed due to not being able to initiate
703  *	authentication/association or not receiving a response from the AP.
704  *	Non-zero %NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE value is indicated in that case as
705  *	well to remain backwards compatible.
706  * @NL80211_CMD_ROAM: Notification indicating the card/driver roamed by itself.
707  *	When a security association was established on an 802.1X network using
708  *	fast transition, this event should be followed by an
709  *	%NL80211_CMD_PORT_AUTHORIZED event.
710  *	Following a %NL80211_CMD_ROAM event userspace can issue
711  *	%NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN in order to obtain the scan information for the
712  *	new BSS the card/driver roamed to.
713  * @NL80211_CMD_DISCONNECT: drop a given connection; also used to notify
714  *	userspace that a connection was dropped by the AP or due to other
715  *	reasons, for this the %NL80211_ATTR_DISCONNECTED_BY_AP and
716  *	%NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE attributes are used.
717  *
718  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY_NETNS: Set a wiphy's netns. Note that all devices
719  *	associated with this wiphy must be down and will follow.
720  *
721  * @NL80211_CMD_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: Request to remain awake on the specified
722  *	channel for the specified amount of time. This can be used to do
723  *	off-channel operations like transmit a Public Action frame and wait for
724  *	a response while being associated to an AP on another channel.
725  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to specify which interface (and thus
726  *	radio) is used. %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ is used to specify the
727  *	frequency for the operation.
728  *	%NL80211_ATTR_DURATION is used to specify the duration in milliseconds
729  *	to remain on the channel. This command is also used as an event to
730  *	notify when the requested duration starts (it may take a while for the
731  *	driver to schedule this time due to other concurrent needs for the
732  *	radio).
733  *	When called, this operation returns a cookie (%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE)
734  *	that will be included with any events pertaining to this request;
735  *	the cookie is also used to cancel the request.
736  * @NL80211_CMD_CANCEL_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: This command can be used to cancel a
737  *	pending remain-on-channel duration if the desired operation has been
738  *	completed prior to expiration of the originally requested duration.
739  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY or %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to specify the
740  *	radio. The %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE attribute must be given as well to
741  *	uniquely identify the request.
742  *	This command is also used as an event to notify when a requested
743  *	remain-on-channel duration has expired.
744  *
745  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_TX_BITRATE_MASK: Set the mask of rates to be used in TX
746  *	rate selection. %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to specify the interface
747  *	and @NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES the set of allowed rates.
748  *
749  * @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME: Register for receiving certain mgmt frames
750  *	(via @NL80211_CMD_FRAME) for processing in userspace. This command
751  *	requires an interface index, a frame type attribute (optional for
752  *	backward compatibility reasons, if not given assumes action frames)
753  *	and a match attribute containing the first few bytes of the frame
754  *	that should match, e.g. a single byte for only a category match or
755  *	four bytes for vendor frames including the OUI. The registration
756  *	cannot be dropped, but is removed automatically when the netlink
757  *	socket is closed. Multiple registrations can be made.
758  *	The %NL80211_ATTR_RECEIVE_MULTICAST flag attribute can be given if
759  *	%NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MULTICAST_REGISTRATIONS is available, in which
760  *	case the registration can also be modified to include/exclude the
761  *	flag, rather than requiring unregistration to change it.
762  * @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_ACTION: Alias for @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME for
763  *	backward compatibility
764  * @NL80211_CMD_FRAME: Management frame TX request and RX notification. This
765  *	command is used both as a request to transmit a management frame and
766  *	as an event indicating reception of a frame that was not processed in
767  *	kernel code, but is for us (i.e., which may need to be processed in a
768  *	user space application). %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME is used to specify the
769  *	frame contents (including header). %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ is used
770  *	to indicate on which channel the frame is to be transmitted or was
771  *	received. If this channel is not the current channel (remain-on-channel
772  *	or the operational channel) the device will switch to the given channel
773  *	and transmit the frame, optionally waiting for a response for the time
774  *	specified using %NL80211_ATTR_DURATION. When called, this operation
775  *	returns a cookie (%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE) that will be included with the
776  *	TX status event pertaining to the TX request.
777  *	%NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE is used to decide whether to send the
778  *	management frames at CCK rate or not in 2GHz band.
779  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFFSETS_TX is an array of offsets to CSA
780  *	counters which will be updated to the current value. This attribute
781  *	is used during CSA period.
782  *	For TX on an MLD, the frequency can be omitted and the link ID be
783  *	specified, or if transmitting to a known peer MLD (with MLD addresses
784  *	in the frame) both can be omitted and the link will be selected by
785  *	lower layers.
786  *	For RX notification, %NL80211_ATTR_RX_HW_TIMESTAMP may be included to
787  *	indicate the frame RX timestamp and %NL80211_ATTR_TX_HW_TIMESTAMP may
788  *	be included to indicate the ack TX timestamp.
789  * @NL80211_CMD_FRAME_WAIT_CANCEL: When an off-channel TX was requested, this
790  *	command may be used with the corresponding cookie to cancel the wait
791  *	time if it is known that it is no longer necessary.  This command is
792  *	also sent as an event whenever the driver has completed the off-channel
793  *	wait time.
794  * @NL80211_CMD_ACTION: Alias for @NL80211_CMD_FRAME for backward compatibility.
795  * @NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS: Report TX status of a management frame
796  *	transmitted with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME. %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE identifies
797  *	the TX command and %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME includes the contents of the
798  *	frame. %NL80211_ATTR_ACK flag is included if the recipient acknowledged
799  *	the frame. %NL80211_ATTR_TX_HW_TIMESTAMP may be included to indicate the
800  *	tx timestamp and %NL80211_ATTR_RX_HW_TIMESTAMP may be included to
801  *	indicate the ack RX timestamp.
802  * @NL80211_CMD_ACTION_TX_STATUS: Alias for @NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS for
803  *	backward compatibility.
804  *
805  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_POWER_SAVE: Set powersave, using %NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE
806  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_POWER_SAVE: Get powersave status in %NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE
807  *
808  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_CQM: Connection quality monitor configuration. This command
809  *	is used to configure connection quality monitoring notification trigger
810  *	levels.
811  * @NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM: Connection quality monitor notification. This
812  *	command is used as an event to indicate the that a trigger level was
813  *	reached.
814  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_CHANNEL: Set the channel (using %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ
815  *	and the attributes determining channel width) the given interface
816  *	(identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX) shall operate on.
817  *	In case multiple channels are supported by the device, the mechanism
818  *	with which it switches channels is implementation-defined.
819  *	When a monitor interface is given, it can only switch channel while
820  *	no other interfaces are operating to avoid disturbing the operation
821  *	of any other interfaces, and other interfaces will again take
822  *	precedence when they are used.
823  *
824  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WDS_PEER: Set the MAC address of the peer on a WDS interface
825  *	(no longer supported).
826  *
827  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST: Configure if this AP should perform
828  *	multicast to unicast conversion. When enabled, all multicast packets
829  *	with ethertype ARP, IPv4 or IPv6 (possibly within an 802.1Q header)
830  *	will be sent out to each station once with the destination (multicast)
831  *	MAC address replaced by the station's MAC address. Note that this may
832  *	break certain expectations of the receiver, e.g. the ability to drop
833  *	unicast IP packets encapsulated in multicast L2 frames, or the ability
834  *	to not send destination unreachable messages in such cases.
835  *	This can only be toggled per BSS. Configure this on an interface of
836  *	type %NL80211_IFTYPE_AP. It applies to all its VLAN interfaces
837  *	(%NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN), except for those in 4addr (WDS) mode.
838  *	If %NL80211_ATTR_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST_ENABLED is not present with this
839  *	command, the feature is disabled.
840  *
841  * @NL80211_CMD_JOIN_MESH: Join a mesh. The mesh ID must be given, and initial
842  *	mesh config parameters may be given.
843  * @NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_MESH: Leave the mesh network -- no special arguments, the
844  *	network is determined by the network interface.
845  *
846  * @NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DEAUTHENTICATE: Unprotected deauthentication frame
847  *	notification. This event is used to indicate that an unprotected
848  *	deauthentication frame was dropped when MFP is in use.
849  * @NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DISASSOCIATE: Unprotected disassociation frame
850  *	notification. This event is used to indicate that an unprotected
851  *	disassociation frame was dropped when MFP is in use.
852  *
853  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE: Notification on the reception of a
854  *      beacon or probe response from a compatible mesh peer.  This is only
855  *      sent while no station information (sta_info) exists for the new peer
856  *      candidate and when @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH,
857  *      @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE, or
858  *      @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM is set.  On reception of this
859  *      notification, userspace may decide to create a new station
860  *      (@NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION).  To stop this notification from
861  *      reoccurring, the userspace authentication daemon may want to create the
862  *      new station with the AUTHENTICATED flag unset and maybe change it later
863  *      depending on the authentication result.
864  *
865  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_WOWLAN: get Wake-on-Wireless-LAN (WoWLAN) settings.
866  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN: set Wake-on-Wireless-LAN (WoWLAN) settings.
867  *	Since wireless is more complex than wired ethernet, it supports
868  *	various triggers. These triggers can be configured through this
869  *	command with the %NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS attribute. For
870  *	more background information, see
871  *	https://wireless.wiki.kernel.org/en/users/Documentation/WoWLAN.
872  *	The @NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN command can also be used as a notification
873  *	from the driver reporting the wakeup reason. In this case, the
874  *	@NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS attribute will contain the reason
875  *	for the wakeup, if it was caused by wireless. If it is not present
876  *	in the wakeup notification, the wireless device didn't cause the
877  *	wakeup but reports that it was woken up.
878  *
879  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_REKEY_OFFLOAD: This command is used give the driver
880  *	the necessary information for supporting GTK rekey offload. This
881  *	feature is typically used during WoWLAN. The configuration data
882  *	is contained in %NL80211_ATTR_REKEY_DATA (which is nested and
883  *	contains the data in sub-attributes). After rekeying happened,
884  *	this command may also be sent by the driver as an MLME event to
885  *	inform userspace of the new replay counter.
886  *
887  * @NL80211_CMD_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: This is used as an event to inform userspace
888  *	of PMKSA caching candidates.
889  *
890  * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER: Perform a high-level TDLS command (e.g. link setup).
891  *	In addition, this can be used as an event to request userspace to take
892  *	actions on TDLS links (set up a new link or tear down an existing one).
893  *	In such events, %NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION indicates the requested
894  *	operation, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC contains the peer MAC address, and
895  *	%NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE the reason code to be used (only with
896  *	%NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN).
897  * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT: Send a TDLS management frame. The
898  *	%NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_ACTION attribute determines the type of frame to be
899  *	sent. Public Action codes (802.11-2012 8.1.5.1) will be sent as
900  *	802.11 management frames, while TDLS action codes (802.11-2012
901  *	8.5.13.1) will be encapsulated and sent as data frames. The currently
902  *	supported Public Action code is %WLAN_PUB_ACTION_TDLS_DISCOVER_RES
903  *	and the currently supported TDLS actions codes are given in
904  *	&enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode.
905  *
906  * @NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_FRAME: Used by an application controlling an AP
907  *	(or GO) interface (i.e. hostapd) to ask for unexpected frames to
908  *	implement sending deauth to stations that send unexpected class 3
909  *	frames. Also used as the event sent by the kernel when such a frame
910  *	is received.
911  *	For the event, the %NL80211_ATTR_MAC attribute carries the TA and
912  *	other attributes like the interface index are present.
913  *	If used as the command it must have an interface index and you can
914  *	only unsubscribe from the event by closing the socket. Subscription
915  *	is also for %NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_4ADDR_FRAME events.
916  *
917  * @NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_4ADDR_FRAME: Sent as an event indicating that the
918  *	associated station identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC sent a 4addr frame
919  *	and wasn't already in a 4-addr VLAN. The event will be sent similarly
920  *	to the %NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_FRAME event, to the same listener.
921  *
922  * @NL80211_CMD_PROBE_CLIENT: Probe an associated station on an AP interface
923  *	by sending a null data frame to it and reporting when the frame is
924  *	acknowledged. This is used to allow timing out inactive clients. Uses
925  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. The command returns a
926  *	direct reply with an %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE that is later used to match
927  *	up the event with the request. The event includes the same data and
928  *	has %NL80211_ATTR_ACK set if the frame was ACKed.
929  *
930  * @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_BEACONS: Register this socket to receive beacons from
931  *	other BSSes when any interfaces are in AP mode. This helps implement
932  *	OLBC handling in hostapd. Beacons are reported in %NL80211_CMD_FRAME
933  *	messages. Note that per PHY only one application may register.
934  *
935  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_NOACK_MAP: sets a bitmap for the individual TIDs whether
936  *      No Acknowledgement Policy should be applied.
937  *
938  * @NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_NOTIFY: An AP or GO may decide to switch channels
939  *	independently of the userspace SME, send this event indicating
940  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is now on %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and the
941  *	attributes determining channel width.  This indication may also be
942  *	sent when a remotely-initiated switch (e.g., when a STA receives a CSA
943  *	from the remote AP) is completed;
944  *
945  * @NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_STARTED_NOTIFY: Notify that a channel switch
946  *	has been started on an interface, regardless of the initiator
947  *	(ie. whether it was requested from a remote device or
948  *	initiated on our own).  It indicates that
949  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX will be on %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ
950  *	after %NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT TBTT's.  The userspace may
951  *	decide to react to this indication by requesting other
952  *	interfaces to change channel as well.
953  *
954  * @NL80211_CMD_START_P2P_DEVICE: Start the given P2P Device, identified by
955  *	its %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV identifier. It must have been created with
956  *	%NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE previously. After it has been started, the
957  *	P2P Device can be used for P2P operations, e.g. remain-on-channel and
958  *	public action frame TX.
959  * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_P2P_DEVICE: Stop the given P2P Device, identified by
960  *	its %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV identifier.
961  *
962  * @NL80211_CMD_CONN_FAILED: connection request to an AP failed; used to
963  *	notify userspace that AP has rejected the connection request from a
964  *	station, due to particular reason. %NL80211_ATTR_CONN_FAILED_REASON
965  *	is used for this.
966  *
967  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MCAST_RATE: Change the rate used to send multicast frames
968  *	for IBSS or MESH vif.
969  *
970  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MAC_ACL: sets ACL for MAC address based access control.
971  *	This is to be used with the drivers advertising the support of MAC
972  *	address based access control. List of MAC addresses is passed in
973  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS and ACL policy is passed in
974  *	%NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY. Driver will enable ACL with this list, if it
975  *	is not already done. The new list will replace any existing list. Driver
976  *	will clear its ACL when the list of MAC addresses passed is empty. This
977  *	command is used in AP/P2P GO mode. Driver has to make sure to clear its
978  *	ACL list during %NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP.
979  *
980  * @NL80211_CMD_RADAR_DETECT: Start a Channel availability check (CAC). Once
981  *	a radar is detected or the channel availability scan (CAC) has finished
982  *	or was aborted, or a radar was detected, usermode will be notified with
983  *	this event. This command is also used to notify userspace about radars
984  *	while operating on this channel.
985  *	%NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT is used to inform about the type of the
986  *	event.
987  *
988  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_PROTOCOL_FEATURES: Get global nl80211 protocol features,
989  *	i.e. features for the nl80211 protocol rather than device features.
990  *	Returns the features in the %NL80211_ATTR_PROTOCOL_FEATURES bitmap.
991  *
992  * @NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_FT_IES: Pass down the most up-to-date Fast Transition
993  *	Information Element to the WLAN driver
994  *
995  * @NL80211_CMD_FT_EVENT: Send a Fast transition event from the WLAN driver
996  *	to the supplicant. This will carry the target AP's MAC address along
997  *	with the relevant Information Elements. This event is used to report
998  *	received FT IEs (MDIE, FTIE, RSN IE, TIE, RICIE).
999  *
1000  * @NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_START: Indicates user-space will start running
1001  *	a critical protocol that needs more reliability in the connection to
1002  *	complete.
1003  *
1004  * @NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_STOP: Indicates the connection reliability can
1005  *	return back to normal.
1006  *
1007  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_COALESCE: Get currently supported coalesce rules.
1008  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_COALESCE: Configure coalesce rules or clear existing rules.
1009  *
1010  * @NL80211_CMD_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Perform a channel switch by announcing the
1011  *	new channel information (Channel Switch Announcement - CSA)
1012  *	in the beacon for some time (as defined in the
1013  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT parameter) and then change to the
1014  *	new channel. Userspace provides the new channel information (using
1015  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and the attributes determining channel
1016  *	width). %NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_BLOCK_TX may be supplied to inform
1017  *	other station that transmission must be blocked until the channel
1018  *	switch is complete.
1019  *
1020  * @NL80211_CMD_VENDOR: Vendor-specified command/event. The command is specified
1021  *	by the %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_ID attribute and a sub-command in
1022  *	%NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_SUBCMD. Parameter(s) can be transported in
1023  *	%NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA.
1024  *	For feature advertisement, the %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA attribute is
1025  *	used in the wiphy data as a nested attribute containing descriptions
1026  *	(&struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info) of the supported vendor commands.
1027  *	This may also be sent as an event with the same attributes.
1028  *
1029  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_QOS_MAP: Set Interworking QoS mapping for IP DSCP values.
1030  *	The QoS mapping information is included in %NL80211_ATTR_QOS_MAP. If
1031  *	that attribute is not included, QoS mapping is disabled. Since this
1032  *	QoS mapping is relevant for IP packets, it is only valid during an
1033  *	association. This is cleared on disassociation and AP restart.
1034  *
1035  * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_TX_TS: Ask the kernel to add a traffic stream for the given
1036  *	%NL80211_ATTR_TSID and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC with %NL80211_ATTR_USER_PRIO
1037  *	and %NL80211_ATTR_ADMITTED_TIME parameters.
1038  *	Note that the action frame handshake with the AP shall be handled by
1039  *	userspace via the normal management RX/TX framework, this only sets
1040  *	up the TX TS in the driver/device.
1041  *	If the admitted time attribute is not added then the request just checks
1042  *	if a subsequent setup could be successful, the intent is to use this to
1043  *	avoid setting up a session with the AP when local restrictions would
1044  *	make that impossible. However, the subsequent "real" setup may still
1045  *	fail even if the check was successful.
1046  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_TX_TS: Remove an existing TS with the %NL80211_ATTR_TSID
1047  *	and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC parameters. It isn't necessary to call this
1048  *	before removing a station entry entirely, or before disassociating
1049  *	or similar, cleanup will happen in the driver/device in this case.
1050  *
1051  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_MPP: Get mesh path attributes for mesh proxy path to
1052  *	destination %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by
1053  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
1054  *
1055  * @NL80211_CMD_JOIN_OCB: Join the OCB network. The center frequency and
1056  *	bandwidth of a channel must be given.
1057  * @NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_OCB: Leave the OCB network -- no special arguments, the
1058  *	network is determined by the network interface.
1059  *
1060  * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer,
1061  *	identified by the %NL80211_ATTR_MAC parameter. A target channel is
1062  *	provided via %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and other attributes determining
1063  *	channel width/type. The target operating class is given via
1064  *	%NL80211_ATTR_OPER_CLASS.
1065  *	The driver is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching
1066  *	operations and returning to the base channel for communication with the
1067  *	AP.
1068  * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CANCEL_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS
1069  *	peer given by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. Both peers must be on the base channel
1070  *	when this command completes.
1071  *
1072  * @NL80211_CMD_WIPHY_REG_CHANGE: Similar to %NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE, but used
1073  *	as an event to indicate changes for devices with wiphy-specific regdom
1074  *	management.
1075  *
1076  * @NL80211_CMD_ABORT_SCAN: Stop an ongoing scan. Returns -ENOENT if a scan is
1077  *	not running. The driver indicates the status of the scan through
1078  *	cfg80211_scan_done().
1079  *
1080  * @NL80211_CMD_START_NAN: Start NAN operation, identified by its
1081  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WDEV interface. This interface must have been
1082  *	previously created with %NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE. After it
1083  *	has been started, the NAN interface will create or join a
1084  *	cluster. This command must have a valid
1085  *	%NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF attribute and optional
1086  *	%NL80211_ATTR_BANDS attributes.  If %NL80211_ATTR_BANDS is
1087  *	omitted or set to 0, it means don't-care and the device will
1088  *	decide what to use.  After this command NAN functions can be
1089  *	added.
1090  * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_NAN: Stop the NAN operation, identified by
1091  *	its %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV interface.
1092  * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_NAN_FUNCTION: Add a NAN function. The function is defined
1093  *	with %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC nested attribute. When called, this
1094  *	operation returns the strictly positive and unique instance id
1095  *	(%NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC_INST_ID) and a cookie (%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE)
1096  *	of the function upon success.
1097  *	Since instance ID's can be re-used, this cookie is the right
1098  *	way to identify the function. This will avoid races when a termination
1099  *	event is handled by the user space after it has already added a new
1100  *	function that got the same instance id from the kernel as the one
1101  *	which just terminated.
1102  *	This cookie may be used in NAN events even before the command
1103  *	returns, so userspace shouldn't process NAN events until it processes
1104  *	the response to this command.
1105  *	Look at %NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER as well.
1106  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_NAN_FUNCTION: Delete a NAN function by cookie.
1107  *	This command is also used as a notification sent when a NAN function is
1108  *	terminated. This will contain a %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC_INST_ID
1109  *	and %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE attributes.
1110  * @NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG: Change current NAN
1111  *	configuration. NAN must be operational (%NL80211_CMD_START_NAN
1112  *	was executed).  It must contain at least one of the following
1113  *	attributes: %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF,
1114  *	%NL80211_ATTR_BANDS.  If %NL80211_ATTR_BANDS is omitted, the
1115  *	current configuration is not changed.  If it is present but
1116  *	set to zero, the configuration is changed to don't-care
1117  *	(i.e. the device can decide what to do).
1118  * @NL80211_CMD_NAN_MATCH: Notification sent when a match is reported.
1119  *	This will contain a %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MATCH nested attribute and
1120  *	%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE.
1121  *
1122  * @NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_CONNECT_PARAMS: Update one or more connect parameters
1123  *	for subsequent roaming cases if the driver or firmware uses internal
1124  *	BSS selection. This command can be issued only while connected and it
1125  *	does not result in a change for the current association. Currently,
1126  *	only the %NL80211_ATTR_IE data is used and updated with this command.
1127  *
1128  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK: For offloaded 4-Way handshake, set the PMK or PMK-R0
1129  *	for the given authenticator address (specified with %NL80211_ATTR_MAC).
1130  *	When %NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME is set, %NL80211_ATTR_PMK specifies the
1131  *	PMK-R0, otherwise it specifies the PMK.
1132  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMK: For offloaded 4-Way handshake, delete the previously
1133  *	configured PMK for the authenticator address identified by
1134  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC.
1135  * @NL80211_CMD_PORT_AUTHORIZED: An event that indicates port is authorized and
1136  *	open for regular data traffic. For STA/P2P-client, this event is sent
1137  *	with AP MAC address and for AP/P2P-GO, the event carries the STA/P2P-
1138  *	client MAC address.
1139  *	Drivers that support 4 way handshake offload should send this event for
1140  *	STA/P2P-client after successful 4-way HS or after 802.1X FT following
1141  *	NL80211_CMD_CONNECT or NL80211_CMD_ROAM. Drivers using AP/P2P-GO 4-way
1142  *	handshake offload should send this event on successful completion of
1143  *	4-way handshake with the peer (STA/P2P-client).
1144  * @NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME: Control Port (e.g. PAE) frame TX request
1145  *	and RX notification.  This command is used both as a request to transmit
1146  *	a control port frame and as a notification that a control port frame
1147  *	has been received. %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME is used to specify the
1148  *	frame contents.  The frame is the raw EAPoL data, without ethernet or
1149  *	802.11 headers.
1150  *	For an MLD transmitter, the %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID may be given and
1151  *	its effect will depend on the destination: If the destination is known
1152  *	to be an MLD, this will be used as a hint to select the link to transmit
1153  *	the frame on. If the destination is not an MLD, this will select both
1154  *	the link to transmit on and the source address will be set to the link
1155  *	address of that link.
1156  *	When used as an event indication %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE,
1157  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC are added
1158  *	indicating the protocol type of the received frame; whether the frame
1159  *	was received unencrypted and the MAC address of the peer respectively.
1160  *
1161  * @NL80211_CMD_RELOAD_REGDB: Request that the regdb firmware file is reloaded.
1162  *
1163  * @NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH: This interface is exclusively defined for host
1164  *	drivers that do not define separate commands for authentication and
1165  *	association, but rely on user space for the authentication to happen.
1166  *	This interface acts both as the event request (driver to user space)
1167  *	to trigger the authentication and command response (userspace to
1168  *	driver) to indicate the authentication status.
1169  *
1170  *	User space uses the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT command to the host driver to
1171  *	trigger a connection. The host driver selects a BSS and further uses
1172  *	this interface to offload only the authentication part to the user
1173  *	space. Authentication frames are passed between the driver and user
1174  *	space through the %NL80211_CMD_FRAME interface. Host driver proceeds
1175  *	further with the association after getting successful authentication
1176  *	status. User space indicates the authentication status through
1177  *	%NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE attribute in %NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH
1178  *	command interface.
1179  *
1180  *	Host driver sends MLD address of the AP with %NL80211_ATTR_MLD_ADDR in
1181  *	%NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH event to indicate user space to enable MLO
1182  *	during the authentication offload in STA mode while connecting to MLD
1183  *	APs. Host driver should check %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_SUPPORT flag capability
1184  *	in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to know whether the user space supports enabling
1185  *	MLO during the authentication offload or not.
1186  *	User space should enable MLO during the authentication only when it
1187  *	receives the AP MLD address in authentication offload request. User
1188  *	space shouldn't enable MLO when the authentication offload request
1189  *	doesn't indicate the AP MLD address even if the AP is MLO capable.
1190  *	User space should use %NL80211_ATTR_MLD_ADDR as peer's MLD address and
1191  *	interface address identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX as self MLD
1192  *	address. User space and host driver to use MLD addresses in RA, TA and
1193  *	BSSID fields of the frames between them, and host driver translates the
1194  *	MLD addresses to/from link addresses based on the link chosen for the
1195  *	authentication.
1196  *
1197  *	Host driver reports this status on an authentication failure to the
1198  *	user space through the connect result as the user space would have
1199  *	initiated the connection through the connect request.
1200  *
1201  * @NL80211_CMD_STA_OPMODE_CHANGED: An event that notify station's
1202  *	ht opmode or vht opmode changes using any of %NL80211_ATTR_SMPS_MODE,
1203  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH,%NL80211_ATTR_NSS attributes with its
1204  *	address(specified in %NL80211_ATTR_MAC).
1205  *
1206  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, in
1207  *	the %NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS attribute.
1208  *
1209  * @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_START: start a (set of) peer measurement(s)
1210  *	with the given parameters, which are encapsulated in the nested
1211  *	%NL80211_ATTR_PEER_MEASUREMENTS attribute. Optionally, MAC address
1212  *	randomization may be enabled and configured by specifying the
1213  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK attributes.
1214  *	If a timeout is requested, use the %NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT attribute.
1215  *	A u64 cookie for further %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE use is returned in
1216  *	the netlink extended ack message.
1217  *
1218  *	To cancel a measurement, close the socket that requested it.
1219  *
1220  *	Measurement results are reported to the socket that requested the
1221  *	measurement using @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_RESULT when they
1222  *	become available, so applications must ensure a large enough socket
1223  *	buffer size.
1224  *
1225  *	Depending on driver support it may or may not be possible to start
1226  *	multiple concurrent measurements.
1227  * @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_RESULT: This command number is used for the
1228  *	result notification from the driver to the requesting socket.
1229  * @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_COMPLETE: Notification only, indicating that
1230  *	the measurement completed, using the measurement cookie
1231  *	(%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE).
1232  *
1233  * @NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_RADAR: Notify the kernel that a radar signal was
1234  *	detected and reported by a neighboring device on the channel
1235  *	indicated by %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and other attributes
1236  *	determining the width and type.
1237  *
1238  * @NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_OWE_INFO: This interface allows the host driver to
1239  *	offload OWE processing to user space. This intends to support
1240  *	OWE AKM by the host drivers that implement SME but rely
1241  *	on the user space for the cryptographic/DH IE processing in AP mode.
1242  *
1243  * @NL80211_CMD_PROBE_MESH_LINK: The requirement for mesh link metric
1244  *	refreshing, is that from one mesh point we be able to send some data
1245  *	frames to other mesh points which are not currently selected as a
1246  *	primary traffic path, but which are only 1 hop away. The absence of
1247  *	the primary path to the chosen node makes it necessary to apply some
1248  *	form of marking on a chosen packet stream so that the packets can be
1249  *	properly steered to the selected node for testing, and not by the
1250  *	regular mesh path lookup. Further, the packets must be of type data
1251  *	so that the rate control (often embedded in firmware) is used for
1252  *	rate selection.
1253  *
1254  *	Here attribute %NL80211_ATTR_MAC is used to specify connected mesh
1255  *	peer MAC address and %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME is used to specify the frame
1256  *	content. The frame is ethernet data.
1257  *
1258  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG: Data frame TID specific configuration
1259  *	is passed using %NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG attribute.
1260  *
1261  * @NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_BEACON: Unprotected or incorrectly protected Beacon
1262  *	frame. This event is used to indicate that a received Beacon frame was
1263  *	dropped because it did not include a valid MME MIC while beacon
1264  *	protection was enabled (BIGTK configured in station mode).
1265  *
1266  * @NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME_TX_STATUS: Report TX status of a control
1267  *	port frame transmitted with %NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME.
1268  *	%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE identifies the TX command and %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME
1269  *	includes the contents of the frame. %NL80211_ATTR_ACK flag is included
1270  *	if the recipient acknowledged the frame.
1271  *
1272  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_SAR_SPECS: SAR power limitation configuration is
1273  *	passed using %NL80211_ATTR_SAR_SPEC. %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY is used to
1274  *	specify the wiphy index to be applied to.
1275  *
1276  * @NL80211_CMD_OBSS_COLOR_COLLISION: This notification is sent out whenever
1277  *	mac80211/drv detects a bss color collision.
1278  *
1279  * @NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_REQUEST: This command is used to indicate that
1280  *	userspace wants to change the BSS color.
1281  *
1282  * @NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_STARTED: Notify userland, that a color change has
1283  *	started
1284  *
1285  * @NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_ABORTED: Notify userland, that the color change has
1286  *	been aborted
1287  *
1288  * @NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_COMPLETED: Notify userland that the color change
1289  *	has completed
1290  *
1291  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_FILS_AAD: Set FILS AAD data to the driver using -
1292  *	&NL80211_ATTR_MAC - for STA MAC address
1293  *	&NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK - for KEK
1294  *	&NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES - for FILS Nonces
1295  *		(STA Nonce 16 bytes followed by AP Nonce 16 bytes)
1296  *
1297  * @NL80211_CMD_ASSOC_COMEBACK: notification about an association
1298  *      temporal rejection with comeback. The event includes %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
1299  *      to describe the BSSID address of the AP and %NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT to
1300  *      specify the timeout value.
1301  *
1302  * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_LINK: Add a new link to an interface. The
1303  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID attribute is used for the new link.
1304  * @NL80211_CMD_REMOVE_LINK: Remove a link from an interface. This may come
1305  *	without %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID as an easy way to remove all links
1306  *	in preparation for e.g. roaming to a regular (non-MLO) AP.
1307  *
1308  * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_LINK_STA: Add a link to an MLD station
1309  * @NL80211_CMD_MODIFY_LINK_STA: Modify a link of an MLD station
1310  * @NL80211_CMD_REMOVE_LINK_STA: Remove a link of an MLD station
1311  *
1312  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_HW_TIMESTAMP: Enable/disable HW timestamping of Timing
1313  *	measurement and Fine timing measurement frames. If %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
1314  *	is included, enable/disable HW timestamping only for frames to/from the
1315  *	specified MAC address. Otherwise enable/disable HW timestamping for
1316  *	all TM/FTM frames (including ones that were enabled with specific MAC
1317  *	address). If %NL80211_ATTR_HW_TIMESTAMP_ENABLED is not included, disable
1318  *	HW timestamping.
1319  *	The number of peers that HW timestamping can be enabled for concurrently
1320  *	is indicated by %NL80211_ATTR_MAX_HW_TIMESTAMP_PEERS.
1321  *
1322  * @NL80211_CMD_LINKS_REMOVED: Notify userspace about the removal of STA MLD
1323  *	setup links due to AP MLD removing the corresponding affiliated APs with
1324  *	Multi-Link reconfiguration. %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINKS is used to provide
1325  *	information about the removed STA MLD setup links.
1326  *
1327  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_TO_LINK_MAPPING: Set the TID to Link Mapping for a
1328  *      non-AP MLD station. The %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_TTLM_DLINK and
1329  *      %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_TTLM_ULINK attributes are used to specify the
1330  *      TID to Link mapping for downlink/uplink traffic.
1331  *
1332  * @NL80211_CMD_ASSOC_MLO_RECONF: For a non-AP MLD station, request to
1333  *      add/remove links to/from the association.
1334  *
1335  * @NL80211_CMD_EPCS_CFG: EPCS configuration for a station. Used by userland to
1336  *	control EPCS configuration. Used to notify userland on the current state
1337  *	of EPCS.
1338  *
1339  * @NL80211_CMD_MAX: highest used command number
1340  * @__NL80211_CMD_AFTER_LAST: internal use
1341  */
1342 enum nl80211_commands {
1343 /* don't change the order or add anything between, this is ABI! */
1344 	NL80211_CMD_UNSPEC,
1345 
1346 	NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY,		/* can dump */
1347 	NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY,
1348 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_WIPHY,
1349 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_WIPHY,
1350 
1351 	NL80211_CMD_GET_INTERFACE,	/* can dump */
1352 	NL80211_CMD_SET_INTERFACE,
1353 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE,
1354 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_INTERFACE,
1355 
1356 	NL80211_CMD_GET_KEY,
1357 	NL80211_CMD_SET_KEY,
1358 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY,
1359 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_KEY,
1360 
1361 	NL80211_CMD_GET_BEACON,
1362 	NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON,
1363 	NL80211_CMD_START_AP,
1364 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON = NL80211_CMD_START_AP,
1365 	NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP,
1366 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_BEACON = NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP,
1367 
1368 	NL80211_CMD_GET_STATION,
1369 	NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION,
1370 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION,
1371 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_STATION,
1372 
1373 	NL80211_CMD_GET_MPATH,
1374 	NL80211_CMD_SET_MPATH,
1375 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_MPATH,
1376 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_MPATH,
1377 
1378 	NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS,
1379 
1380 	NL80211_CMD_SET_REG,
1381 	NL80211_CMD_REQ_SET_REG,
1382 
1383 	NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_CONFIG,
1384 	NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_CONFIG,
1385 
1386 	NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE /* reserved; not used */,
1387 
1388 	NL80211_CMD_GET_REG,
1389 
1390 	NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN,
1391 	NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN,
1392 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_SCAN_RESULTS,
1393 	NL80211_CMD_SCAN_ABORTED,
1394 
1395 	NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE,
1396 
1397 	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE,
1398 	NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE,
1399 	NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE,
1400 	NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE,
1401 
1402 	NL80211_CMD_MICHAEL_MIC_FAILURE,
1403 
1404 	NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT,
1405 
1406 	NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS,
1407 	NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_IBSS,
1408 
1409 	NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE,
1410 
1411 	NL80211_CMD_CONNECT,
1412 	NL80211_CMD_ROAM,
1413 	NL80211_CMD_DISCONNECT,
1414 
1415 	NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY_NETNS,
1416 
1417 	NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY,
1418 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_SURVEY_RESULTS,
1419 
1420 	NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA,
1421 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA,
1422 	NL80211_CMD_FLUSH_PMKSA,
1423 
1424 	NL80211_CMD_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL,
1425 	NL80211_CMD_CANCEL_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL,
1426 
1427 	NL80211_CMD_SET_TX_BITRATE_MASK,
1428 
1429 	NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME,
1430 	NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_ACTION = NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME,
1431 	NL80211_CMD_FRAME,
1432 	NL80211_CMD_ACTION = NL80211_CMD_FRAME,
1433 	NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS,
1434 	NL80211_CMD_ACTION_TX_STATUS = NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS,
1435 
1436 	NL80211_CMD_SET_POWER_SAVE,
1437 	NL80211_CMD_GET_POWER_SAVE,
1438 
1439 	NL80211_CMD_SET_CQM,
1440 	NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM,
1441 
1442 	NL80211_CMD_SET_CHANNEL,
1443 	NL80211_CMD_SET_WDS_PEER,
1444 
1445 	NL80211_CMD_FRAME_WAIT_CANCEL,
1446 
1447 	NL80211_CMD_JOIN_MESH,
1448 	NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_MESH,
1449 
1450 	NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DEAUTHENTICATE,
1451 	NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DISASSOCIATE,
1452 
1453 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE,
1454 
1455 	NL80211_CMD_GET_WOWLAN,
1456 	NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN,
1457 
1458 	NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN,
1459 	NL80211_CMD_STOP_SCHED_SCAN,
1460 	NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_RESULTS,
1461 	NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_STOPPED,
1462 
1463 	NL80211_CMD_SET_REKEY_OFFLOAD,
1464 
1465 	NL80211_CMD_PMKSA_CANDIDATE,
1466 
1467 	NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER,
1468 	NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT,
1469 
1470 	NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_FRAME,
1471 
1472 	NL80211_CMD_PROBE_CLIENT,
1473 
1474 	NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_BEACONS,
1475 
1476 	NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_4ADDR_FRAME,
1477 
1478 	NL80211_CMD_SET_NOACK_MAP,
1479 
1480 	NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_NOTIFY,
1481 
1482 	NL80211_CMD_START_P2P_DEVICE,
1483 	NL80211_CMD_STOP_P2P_DEVICE,
1484 
1485 	NL80211_CMD_CONN_FAILED,
1486 
1487 	NL80211_CMD_SET_MCAST_RATE,
1488 
1489 	NL80211_CMD_SET_MAC_ACL,
1490 
1491 	NL80211_CMD_RADAR_DETECT,
1492 
1493 	NL80211_CMD_GET_PROTOCOL_FEATURES,
1494 
1495 	NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_FT_IES,
1496 	NL80211_CMD_FT_EVENT,
1497 
1498 	NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_START,
1499 	NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_STOP,
1500 
1501 	NL80211_CMD_GET_COALESCE,
1502 	NL80211_CMD_SET_COALESCE,
1503 
1504 	NL80211_CMD_CHANNEL_SWITCH,
1505 
1506 	NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
1507 
1508 	NL80211_CMD_SET_QOS_MAP,
1509 
1510 	NL80211_CMD_ADD_TX_TS,
1511 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_TX_TS,
1512 
1513 	NL80211_CMD_GET_MPP,
1514 
1515 	NL80211_CMD_JOIN_OCB,
1516 	NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_OCB,
1517 
1518 	NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_STARTED_NOTIFY,
1519 
1520 	NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH,
1521 	NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CANCEL_CHANNEL_SWITCH,
1522 
1523 	NL80211_CMD_WIPHY_REG_CHANGE,
1524 
1525 	NL80211_CMD_ABORT_SCAN,
1526 
1527 	NL80211_CMD_START_NAN,
1528 	NL80211_CMD_STOP_NAN,
1529 	NL80211_CMD_ADD_NAN_FUNCTION,
1530 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_NAN_FUNCTION,
1531 	NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG,
1532 	NL80211_CMD_NAN_MATCH,
1533 
1534 	NL80211_CMD_SET_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST,
1535 
1536 	NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_CONNECT_PARAMS,
1537 
1538 	NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK,
1539 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMK,
1540 
1541 	NL80211_CMD_PORT_AUTHORIZED,
1542 
1543 	NL80211_CMD_RELOAD_REGDB,
1544 
1545 	NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH,
1546 
1547 	NL80211_CMD_STA_OPMODE_CHANGED,
1548 
1549 	NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME,
1550 
1551 	NL80211_CMD_GET_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS,
1552 
1553 	NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_START,
1554 	NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_RESULT,
1555 	NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_COMPLETE,
1556 
1557 	NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_RADAR,
1558 
1559 	NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_OWE_INFO,
1560 
1561 	NL80211_CMD_PROBE_MESH_LINK,
1562 
1563 	NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG,
1564 
1565 	NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_BEACON,
1566 
1567 	NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME_TX_STATUS,
1568 
1569 	NL80211_CMD_SET_SAR_SPECS,
1570 
1571 	NL80211_CMD_OBSS_COLOR_COLLISION,
1572 
1573 	NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_REQUEST,
1574 
1575 	NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_STARTED,
1576 	NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_ABORTED,
1577 	NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_COMPLETED,
1578 
1579 	NL80211_CMD_SET_FILS_AAD,
1580 
1581 	NL80211_CMD_ASSOC_COMEBACK,
1582 
1583 	NL80211_CMD_ADD_LINK,
1584 	NL80211_CMD_REMOVE_LINK,
1585 
1586 	NL80211_CMD_ADD_LINK_STA,
1587 	NL80211_CMD_MODIFY_LINK_STA,
1588 	NL80211_CMD_REMOVE_LINK_STA,
1589 
1590 	NL80211_CMD_SET_HW_TIMESTAMP,
1591 
1592 	NL80211_CMD_LINKS_REMOVED,
1593 
1594 	NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_TO_LINK_MAPPING,
1595 
1596 	NL80211_CMD_ASSOC_MLO_RECONF,
1597 	NL80211_CMD_EPCS_CFG,
1598 
1599 	/* add new commands above here */
1600 
1601 	/* used to define NL80211_CMD_MAX below */
1602 	__NL80211_CMD_AFTER_LAST,
1603 	NL80211_CMD_MAX = __NL80211_CMD_AFTER_LAST - 1
1604 };
1605 
1606 /*
1607  * Allow user space programs to use #ifdef on new commands by defining them
1608  * here
1609  */
1610 #define NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS
1611 #define NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE
1612 #define NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE
1613 #define NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE
1614 #define NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE
1615 #define NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE
1616 #define NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE
1617 #define NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT
1618 
1619 #define NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS
1620 
1621 /* source-level API compatibility */
1622 #define NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_PARAMS NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_CONFIG
1623 #define NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_PARAMS NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_CONFIG
1624 #define NL80211_MESH_SETUP_VENDOR_PATH_SEL_IE NL80211_MESH_SETUP_IE
1625 
1626 /**
1627  * enum nl80211_attrs - nl80211 netlink attributes
1628  *
1629  * @NL80211_ATTR_UNSPEC: unspecified attribute to catch errors
1630  *
1631  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY: index of wiphy to operate on, cf.
1632  *	/sys/class/ieee80211/<phyname>/index
1633  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME: wiphy name (used for renaming)
1634  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS: a nested array of TX queue parameters
1635  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ: frequency of the selected channel in MHz,
1636  *	defines the channel together with the (deprecated)
1637  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE attribute or the attributes
1638  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH and if needed %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
1639  *	and %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2
1640  * @NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH: u32 attribute containing one of the values
1641  *	of &enum nl80211_chan_width, describing the channel width. See the
1642  *	documentation of the enum for more information.
1643  * @NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1: Center frequency of the first part of the
1644  *	channel, used for anything but 20 MHz bandwidth. In S1G this is the
1645  *	operating channel center frequency.
1646  * @NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2: Center frequency of the second part of the
1647  *	channel, used only for 80+80 MHz bandwidth
1648  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE: included with NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ
1649  *	if HT20 or HT40 are to be used (i.e., HT disabled if not included):
1650  *	NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT = HT not allowed (i.e., same as not including
1651  *		this attribute)
1652  *	NL80211_CHAN_HT20 = HT20 only
1653  *	NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS = secondary channel is below the primary channel
1654  *	NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS = secondary channel is above the primary channel
1655  *	This attribute is now deprecated.
1656  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_SHORT: TX retry limit for frames whose length is
1657  *	less than or equal to the RTS threshold; allowed range: 1..255;
1658  *	dot11ShortRetryLimit; u8
1659  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_LONG: TX retry limit for frames whose length is
1660  *	greater than the RTS threshold; allowed range: 1..255;
1661  *	dot11ShortLongLimit; u8
1662  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FRAG_THRESHOLD: fragmentation threshold, i.e., maximum
1663  *	length in octets for frames; allowed range: 256..8000, disable
1664  *	fragmentation with (u32)-1; dot11FragmentationThreshold; u32
1665  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RTS_THRESHOLD: RTS threshold (TX frames with length
1666  *	larger than or equal to this use RTS/CTS handshake); allowed range:
1667  *	0..65536, disable with (u32)-1; dot11RTSThreshold; u32
1668  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_COVERAGE_CLASS: Coverage Class as defined by IEEE 802.11
1669  *	section 7.3.2.9; dot11CoverageClass; u8
1670  *
1671  * @NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX: network interface index of the device to operate on
1672  * @NL80211_ATTR_IFNAME: network interface name
1673  * @NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE: type of virtual interface, see &enum nl80211_iftype
1674  *
1675  * @NL80211_ATTR_WDEV: wireless device identifier, used for pseudo-devices
1676  *	that don't have a netdev (u64)
1677  *
1678  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC: MAC address (various uses)
1679  *
1680  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DATA: (temporal) key data; for TKIP this consists of
1681  *	16 bytes encryption key followed by 8 bytes each for TX and RX MIC
1682  *	keys
1683  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX: key ID (u8, 0-3)
1684  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_CIPHER: key cipher suite (u32, as defined by IEEE 802.11
1685  *	section 7.3.2.25.1, e.g. 0x000FAC04)
1686  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ: transmit key sequence number (IV/PN) for TKIP and
1687  *	CCMP keys, each six bytes in little endian
1688  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT: Flag attribute indicating the key is default key
1689  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT: Flag attribute indicating the key is the
1690  *	default management key
1691  * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE: For crypto settings for connect or
1692  *	other commands, indicates which pairwise cipher suites are used
1693  * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP: For crypto settings for connect or
1694  *	other commands, indicates which group cipher suite is used
1695  *
1696  * @NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL: beacon interval in TU
1697  * @NL80211_ATTR_DTIM_PERIOD: DTIM period for beaconing
1698  * @NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_HEAD: portion of the beacon before the TIM IE
1699  * @NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL: portion of the beacon after the TIM IE
1700  *
1701  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_AID: Association ID for the station (u16)
1702  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS: flags, nested element with NLA_FLAG attributes of
1703  *	&enum nl80211_sta_flags (deprecated, use %NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS2)
1704  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_LISTEN_INTERVAL: listen interval as defined by
1705  *	IEEE 802.11 7.3.1.6 (u16).
1706  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_RATES: supported rates, array of supported
1707  *	rates as defined by IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 but without the length
1708  *	restriction (at most %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES).
1709  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_VLAN: interface index of VLAN interface to move station
1710  *	to, or the AP interface the station was originally added to.
1711  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_INFO: information about a station, part of station info
1712  *	given for %NL80211_CMD_GET_STATION, nested attribute containing
1713  *	info as possible, see &enum nl80211_sta_info.
1714  *
1715  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_BANDS: Information about an operating bands,
1716  *	consisting of a nested array.
1717  *
1718  * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_ID: mesh id (1-32 bytes).
1719  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_ACTION: action to perform on the mesh peer link
1720  *	(see &enum nl80211_plink_action).
1721  * @NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_NEXT_HOP: MAC address of the next hop for a mesh path.
1722  * @NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_INFO: information about a mesh_path, part of mesh path
1723  *	info given for %NL80211_CMD_GET_MPATH, nested attribute described at
1724  *	&enum nl80211_mpath_info.
1725  *
1726  * @NL80211_ATTR_MNTR_FLAGS: flags, nested element with NLA_FLAG attributes of
1727  *      &enum nl80211_mntr_flags.
1728  *
1729  * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2: an ISO-3166-alpha2 country code for which the
1730  *	current regulatory domain should be set to or is already set to.
1731  *	For example, 'CR', for Costa Rica. This attribute is used by the kernel
1732  *	to query the CRDA to retrieve one regulatory domain. This attribute can
1733  *	also be used by userspace to query the kernel for the currently set
1734  *	regulatory domain. We chose an alpha2 as that is also used by the
1735  *	IEEE-802.11 country information element to identify a country.
1736  *	Users can also simply ask the wireless core to set regulatory domain
1737  *	to a specific alpha2.
1738  * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULES: a nested array of regulatory domain regulatory
1739  *	rules.
1740  *
1741  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled (u8, 0 or 1)
1742  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_PREAMBLE: whether short preamble is enabled
1743  *	(u8, 0 or 1)
1744  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME: whether short slot time enabled
1745  *	(u8, 0 or 1)
1746  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES: basic rates, array of basic
1747  *	rates in format defined by IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 but without the length
1748  *	restriction (at most %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES).
1749  *
1750  * @NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY: HT Capability information element (from
1751  *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION)
1752  *
1753  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES: nested attribute containing all
1754  *	supported interface types, each a flag attribute with the number
1755  *	of the interface mode.
1756  *
1757  * @NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE: Management frame subtype for
1758  *	%NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE.
1759  *
1760  * @NL80211_ATTR_IE: Information element(s) data (used, e.g., with
1761  *	%NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE).
1762  *
1763  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCAN_SSIDS: number of SSIDs you can scan with
1764  *	a single scan request, a wiphy attribute.
1765  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_SSIDS: number of SSIDs you can
1766  *	scan with a single scheduled scan request, a wiphy attribute.
1767  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_IE_LEN: maximum length of information elements
1768  *	that can be added to a scan request
1769  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCHED_SCAN_IE_LEN: maximum length of information
1770  *	elements that can be added to a scheduled scan request
1771  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_MATCH_SETS: maximum number of sets that can be
1772  *	used with @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH, a wiphy attribute.
1773  *
1774  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES: nested attribute with frequencies (in MHz)
1775  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS: nested attribute with SSIDs, leave out for passive
1776  *	scanning and include a zero-length SSID (wildcard) for wildcard scan
1777  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS: scan result BSS
1778  *
1779  * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR: indicates who requested the regulatory domain
1780  *	currently in effect. This could be any of the %NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_*
1781  * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE: indicates the type of the regulatory domain currently
1782  *	set. This can be one of the nl80211_reg_type (%NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_*)
1783  *
1784  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_COMMANDS: wiphy attribute that specifies
1785  *	an array of command numbers (i.e. a mapping index to command number)
1786  *	that the driver for the given wiphy supports.
1787  *
1788  * @NL80211_ATTR_FRAME: frame data (binary attribute), including frame header
1789  *	and body, but not FCS; used, e.g., with NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE and
1790  *	NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE events
1791  * @NL80211_ATTR_SSID: SSID (binary attribute, 0..32 octets)
1792  * @NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE: AuthenticationType, see &enum nl80211_auth_type,
1793  *	represented as a u32
1794  * @NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE: ReasonCode for %NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE and
1795  *	%NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE, u16
1796  *
1797  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_TYPE: Key Type, see &enum nl80211_key_type, represented as
1798  *	a u32
1799  *
1800  * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_BEFORE: A channel which has suffered a regulatory change
1801  *	due to considerations from a beacon hint. This attribute reflects
1802  *	the state of the channel _before_ the beacon hint processing. This
1803  *	attributes consists of a nested attribute containing
1804  *	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_*
1805  * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_AFTER: A channel which has suffered a regulatory change
1806  *	due to considerations from a beacon hint. This attribute reflects
1807  *	the state of the channel _after_ the beacon hint processing. This
1808  *	attributes consists of a nested attribute containing
1809  *	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_*
1810  *
1811  * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES: a set of u32 values indicating the supported
1812  *	cipher suites
1813  *
1814  * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_FIXED: a flag indicating the IBSS should not try to look
1815  *	for other networks on different channels
1816  *
1817  * @NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT: a flag indicating than an operation timed out; this
1818  *	is used, e.g., with %NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE event
1819  *
1820  * @NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP: Whether management frame protection (IEEE 802.11w) is
1821  *	used for the association (&enum nl80211_mfp, represented as a u32);
1822  *	this attribute can be used with %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and
1823  *	%NL80211_CMD_CONNECT requests. %NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL is not allowed for
1824  *	%NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE since user space SME is expected and hence, it
1825  *	must have decided whether to use management frame protection or not.
1826  *	Setting %NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL with a %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT request will
1827  *	let the driver (or the firmware) decide whether to use MFP or not.
1828  *
1829  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS2: Attribute containing a
1830  *	&struct nl80211_sta_flag_update.
1831  *
1832  * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT: A flag indicating whether user space controls
1833  *	IEEE 802.1X port, i.e., sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED, in
1834  *	station mode. If the flag is included in %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE
1835  *	request, the driver will assume that the port is unauthorized until
1836  *	authorized by user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by
1837  *	default in station mode.
1838  * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE: A 16-bit value indicating the
1839  *	ethertype that will be used for key negotiation. It can be
1840  *	specified with the associate and connect commands. If it is not
1841  *	specified, the value defaults to 0x888E (PAE, 802.1X). This
1842  *	attribute is also used as a flag in the wiphy information to
1843  *	indicate that protocols other than PAE are supported.
1844  * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT: When included along with
1845  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE, indicates that the custom
1846  *	ethertype frames used for key negotiation must not be encrypted.
1847  * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211: A flag indicating whether control
1848  *	port frames (e.g. of type given in %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE)
1849  *	will be sent directly to the network interface or sent via the NL80211
1850  *	socket.  If this attribute is missing, then legacy behavior of sending
1851  *	control port frames directly to the network interface is used.  If the
1852  *	flag is included, then control port frames are sent over NL80211 instead
1853  *	using %CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME.  If control port routing over NL80211 is
1854  *	to be used then userspace must also use the %NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER
1855  *	flag. When used with %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH, pre-auth
1856  *	frames are not forwarded over the control port.
1857  *
1858  * @NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA: Testmode data blob, passed through to the driver.
1859  *	We recommend using nested, driver-specific attributes within this.
1860  *
1861  * @NL80211_ATTR_DISCONNECTED_BY_AP: A flag indicating that the DISCONNECT
1862  *	event was due to the AP disconnecting the station, and not due to
1863  *	a local disconnect request.
1864  * @NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE: StatusCode for the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT
1865  *	event (u16)
1866  * @NL80211_ATTR_PRIVACY: Flag attribute, used with connect(), indicating
1867  *	that protected APs should be used. This is also used with NEW_BEACON to
1868  *	indicate that the BSS is to use protection.
1869  *
1870  * @NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON to
1871  *	indicate which WPA version(s) the AP we want to associate with is using
1872  *	(a u32 with flags from &enum nl80211_wpa_versions).
1873  * @NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON to
1874  *	indicate which key management algorithm(s) to use (an array of u32).
1875  *	This attribute is also sent in response to @NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY,
1876  *	indicating the supported AKM suites, intended for specific drivers which
1877  *	implement SME and have constraints on which AKMs are supported and also
1878  *	the cases where an AKM support is offloaded to the driver/firmware.
1879  *	If there is no such notification from the driver, user space should
1880  *	assume the driver supports all the AKM suites.
1881  *
1882  * @NL80211_ATTR_REQ_IE: (Re)association request information elements as
1883  *	sent out by the card, for ROAM and successful CONNECT events.
1884  * @NL80211_ATTR_RESP_IE: (Re)association response information elements as
1885  *	sent by peer, for ROAM and successful CONNECT events.
1886  *
1887  * @NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID: previous BSSID, to be used in ASSOCIATE and CONNECT
1888  *	commands to specify a request to reassociate within an ESS, i.e., to use
1889  *	Reassociate Request frame (with the value of this attribute in the
1890  *	Current AP address field) instead of Association Request frame which is
1891  *	used for the initial association to an ESS.
1892  *
1893  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY: key information in a nested attribute with
1894  *	%NL80211_KEY_* sub-attributes
1895  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEYS: array of keys for static WEP keys for connect()
1896  *	and join_ibss(), key information is in a nested attribute each
1897  *	with %NL80211_KEY_* sub-attributes
1898  *
1899  * @NL80211_ATTR_PID: Process ID of a network namespace.
1900  * @NL80211_ATTR_NETNS_FD: File descriptor of a network namespace.
1901  *
1902  * @NL80211_ATTR_GENERATION: Used to indicate consistent snapshots for
1903  *	dumps. This number increases whenever the object list being
1904  *	dumped changes, and as such userspace can verify that it has
1905  *	obtained a complete and consistent snapshot by verifying that
1906  *	all dump messages contain the same generation number. If it
1907  *	changed then the list changed and the dump should be repeated
1908  *	completely from scratch.
1909  *
1910  * @NL80211_ATTR_4ADDR: Use 4-address frames on a virtual interface
1911  *
1912  * @NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_INFO: survey information about a channel, part of
1913  *      the survey response for %NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY, nested attribute
1914  *      containing info as possible, see &enum survey_info.
1915  *
1916  * @NL80211_ATTR_PMKID: PMK material for PMKSA caching.
1917  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_PMKIDS: maximum number of PMKIDs a firmware can
1918  *	cache, a wiphy attribute.
1919  *
1920  * @NL80211_ATTR_DURATION: Duration of an operation in milliseconds, u32.
1921  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL_DURATION: Device attribute that
1922  *	specifies the maximum duration that can be requested with the
1923  *	remain-on-channel operation, in milliseconds, u32.
1924  *
1925  * @NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE: Generic 64-bit cookie to identify objects.
1926  *
1927  * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES: Nested set of attributes
1928  *	(enum nl80211_tx_rate_attributes) describing TX rates per band. The
1929  *	enum nl80211_band value is used as the index (nla_type() of the nested
1930  *	data. If a band is not included, it will be configured to allow all
1931  *	rates based on negotiated supported rates information. This attribute
1932  *	is used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_TX_BITRATE_MASK and with starting AP,
1933  *	and joining mesh networks (not IBSS yet). In the later case, it must
1934  *	specify just a single bitrate, which is to be used for the beacon.
1935  *	The driver must also specify support for this with the extended
1936  *	features NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_LEGACY,
1937  *	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HT,
1938  *	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_VHT and
1939  *	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HE.
1940  *
1941  * @NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_MATCH: A binary attribute which typically must contain
1942  *	at least one byte, currently used with @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME.
1943  * @NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE: A u16 indicating the frame type/subtype for the
1944  *	@NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME command.
1945  * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_FRAME_TYPES: wiphy capability attribute, which is a
1946  *	nested attribute of %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE attributes, containing
1947  *	information about which frame types can be transmitted with
1948  *	%NL80211_CMD_FRAME.
1949  * @NL80211_ATTR_RX_FRAME_TYPES: wiphy capability attribute, which is a
1950  *	nested attribute of %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE attributes, containing
1951  *	information about which frame types can be registered for RX.
1952  *
1953  * @NL80211_ATTR_ACK: Flag attribute indicating that the frame was
1954  *	acknowledged by the recipient.
1955  * @NL80211_ATTR_ACK_SIGNAL: Station's ack signal strength (s32)
1956  *
1957  * @NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE: powersave state, using &enum nl80211_ps_state values.
1958  *
1959  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM: connection quality monitor configuration in a
1960  *	nested attribute with %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_* sub-attributes.
1961  *
1962  * @NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_STATE_CHANGE: Flag attribute to indicate that a command
1963  *	is requesting a local authentication/association state change without
1964  *	invoking actual management frame exchange. This can be used with
1965  *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE, NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE,
1966  *	NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE.
1967  *
1968  * @NL80211_ATTR_AP_ISOLATE: (AP mode) Do not forward traffic between stations
1969  *	connected to this BSS.
1970  *
1971  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_SETTING: Transmit power setting type. See
1972  *      &enum nl80211_tx_power_setting for possible values.
1973  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_LEVEL: Transmit power level in signed mBm units.
1974  *      This is used in association with @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_SETTING
1975  *      for non-automatic settings.
1976  *
1977  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_IBSS_RSN: The device supports IBSS RSN, which mostly
1978  *	means support for per-station GTKs.
1979  *
1980  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX: Bitmap of allowed antennas for transmitting.
1981  *	This can be used to mask out antennas which are not attached or should
1982  *	not be used for transmitting. If an antenna is not selected in this
1983  *	bitmap the hardware is not allowed to transmit on this antenna.
1984  *
1985  *	Each bit represents one antenna, starting with antenna 1 at the first
1986  *	bit. Depending on which antennas are selected in the bitmap, 802.11n
1987  *	drivers can derive which chainmasks to use (if all antennas belonging to
1988  *	a particular chain are disabled this chain should be disabled) and if
1989  *	a chain has diversity antennas whether diversity should be used or not.
1990  *	HT capabilities (STBC, TX Beamforming, Antenna selection) can be
1991  *	derived from the available chains after applying the antenna mask.
1992  *	Non-802.11n drivers can derive whether to use diversity or not.
1993  *	Drivers may reject configurations or RX/TX mask combinations they cannot
1994  *	support by returning -EINVAL.
1995  *
1996  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_RX: Bitmap of allowed antennas for receiving.
1997  *	This can be used to mask out antennas which are not attached or should
1998  *	not be used for receiving. If an antenna is not selected in this bitmap
1999  *	the hardware should not be configured to receive on this antenna.
2000  *	For a more detailed description see @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX.
2001  *
2002  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_TX: Bitmap of antennas which are available
2003  *	for configuration as TX antennas via the above parameters.
2004  *
2005  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_RX: Bitmap of antennas which are available
2006  *	for configuration as RX antennas via the above parameters.
2007  *
2008  * @NL80211_ATTR_MCAST_RATE: Multicast tx rate (in 100 kbps) for IBSS
2009  *
2010  * @NL80211_ATTR_OFFCHANNEL_TX_OK: For management frame TX, the frame may be
2011  *	transmitted on another channel when the channel given doesn't match
2012  *	the current channel. If the current channel doesn't match and this
2013  *	flag isn't set, the frame will be rejected. This is also used as an
2014  *	nl80211 capability flag.
2015  *
2016  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_HT_OPMODE: HT operation mode (u16)
2017  *
2018  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES: A nested attribute containing flags
2019  *	attributes, specifying what a key should be set as default as.
2020  *	See &enum nl80211_key_default_types.
2021  *
2022  * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_SETUP: Optional mesh setup parameters.  These cannot be
2023  *	changed once the mesh is active.
2024  * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_CONFIG: Mesh configuration parameters, a nested attribute
2025  *	containing attributes from &enum nl80211_meshconf_params.
2026  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_MESH_AUTH: Currently, this means the underlying driver
2027  *	allows auth frames in a mesh to be passed to userspace for processing via
2028  *	the @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH flag.
2029  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_STATE: The state of a mesh peer link as defined in
2030  *	&enum nl80211_plink_state. Used when userspace is driving the peer link
2031  *	management state machine.  @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE or
2032  *	@NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM must be enabled.
2033  *
2034  * @NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED: indicates, as part of the wiphy
2035  *	capabilities, the supported WoWLAN triggers
2036  * @NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS: used by %NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN to
2037  *	indicate which WoW triggers should be enabled. This is also
2038  *	used by %NL80211_CMD_GET_WOWLAN to get the currently enabled WoWLAN
2039  *	triggers.
2040  *
2041  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL: Interval between scheduled scan
2042  *	cycles, in msecs.
2043  *
2044  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH: Nested attribute with one or more
2045  *	sets of attributes to match during scheduled scans.  Only BSSs
2046  *	that match any of the sets will be reported.  These are
2047  *	pass-thru filter rules.
2048  *	For a match to succeed, the BSS must match all attributes of a
2049  *	set.  Since not every hardware supports matching all types of
2050  *	attributes, there is no guarantee that the reported BSSs are
2051  *	fully complying with the match sets and userspace needs to be
2052  *	able to ignore them by itself.
2053  *	Thus, the implementation is somewhat hardware-dependent, but
2054  *	this is only an optimization and the userspace application
2055  *	needs to handle all the non-filtered results anyway.
2056  *	If the match attributes don't make sense when combined with
2057  *	the values passed in @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS (eg. if an SSID
2058  *	is included in the probe request, but the match attributes
2059  *	will never let it go through), -EINVAL may be returned.
2060  *	If omitted, no filtering is done.
2061  *
2062  * @NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS: Nested attribute listing the supported
2063  *	interface combinations. In each nested item, it contains attributes
2064  *	defined in &enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs.
2065  *	If the wiphy uses multiple radios (@NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RADIOS is set),
2066  *	this attribute contains the interface combinations of the first radio.
2067  *	See @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS for the global wiphy
2068  *	combinations for the sum of all radios.
2069  * @NL80211_ATTR_SOFTWARE_IFTYPES: Nested attribute (just like
2070  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES) containing the interface types that
2071  *	are managed in software: interfaces of these types aren't subject to
2072  *	any restrictions in their number or combinations.
2073  *
2074  * @NL80211_ATTR_REKEY_DATA: nested attribute containing the information
2075  *	necessary for GTK rekeying in the device, see &enum nl80211_rekey_data.
2076  *
2077  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SUPP_RATES: rates per to be advertised as supported in scan,
2078  *	nested array attribute containing an entry for each band, with the entry
2079  *	being a list of supported rates as defined by IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 but
2080  *	without the length restriction (at most %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES).
2081  *
2082  * @NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID: indicates whether SSID is to be hidden from Beacon
2083  *	and Probe Response (when response to wildcard Probe Request); see
2084  *	&enum nl80211_hidden_ssid, represented as a u32
2085  *
2086  * @NL80211_ATTR_IE_PROBE_RESP: Information element(s) for Probe Response frame.
2087  *	This is used with %NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON and %NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON to
2088  *	provide extra IEs (e.g., WPS/P2P IE) into Probe Response frames when the
2089  *	driver (or firmware) replies to Probe Request frames.
2090  * @NL80211_ATTR_IE_ASSOC_RESP: Information element(s) for (Re)Association
2091  *	Response frames. This is used with %NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON and
2092  *	%NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON to provide extra IEs (e.g., WPS/P2P IE) into
2093  *	(Re)Association Response frames when the driver (or firmware) replies to
2094  *	(Re)Association Request frames.
2095  *
2096  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_WME: Nested attribute containing the wme configuration
2097  *	of the station, see &enum nl80211_sta_wme_attr.
2098  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_AP_UAPSD: the device supports uapsd when working
2099  *	as AP.
2100  *
2101  * @NL80211_ATTR_ROAM_SUPPORT: Indicates whether the firmware is capable of
2102  *	roaming to another AP in the same ESS if the signal lever is low.
2103  *
2104  * @NL80211_ATTR_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: Nested attribute containing the PMKSA caching
2105  *	candidate information, see &enum nl80211_pmksa_candidate_attr.
2106  *
2107  * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE: Indicates whether to use CCK rate or not
2108  *	for management frames transmission. In order to avoid p2p probe/action
2109  *	frames are being transmitted at CCK rate in 2GHz band, the user space
2110  *	applications use this attribute.
2111  *	This attribute is used with %NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN and
2112  *	%NL80211_CMD_FRAME commands.
2113  *
2114  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_ACTION: Low level TDLS action code (e.g. link setup
2115  *	request, link setup confirm, link teardown, etc.). Values are
2116  *	described in the TDLS (802.11z) specification.
2117  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_DIALOG_TOKEN: Non-zero token for uniquely identifying a
2118  *	TDLS conversation between two devices.
2119  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION: High level TDLS operation; see
2120  *	&enum nl80211_tdls_operation, represented as a u8.
2121  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_SUPPORT: A flag indicating the device can operate
2122  *	as a TDLS peer sta.
2123  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP: The TDLS discovery/setup and teardown
2124  *	procedures should be performed by sending TDLS packets via
2125  *	%NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT. Otherwise %NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER should be
2126  *	used for asking the driver to perform a TDLS operation.
2127  *
2128  * @NL80211_ATTR_DEVICE_AP_SME: This u32 attribute may be listed for devices
2129  *	that have AP support to indicate that they have the AP SME integrated
2130  *	with support for the features listed in this attribute, see
2131  *	&enum nl80211_ap_sme_features.
2132  *
2133  * @NL80211_ATTR_DONT_WAIT_FOR_ACK: Used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME, this tells
2134  *	the driver to not wait for an acknowledgement. Note that due to this,
2135  *	it will also not give a status callback nor return a cookie. This is
2136  *	mostly useful for probe responses to save airtime.
2137  *
2138  * @NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS: This u32 attribute contains flags from
2139  *	&enum nl80211_feature_flags and is advertised in wiphy information.
2140  * @NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD: Indicates that the HW responds to probe
2141  *	requests while operating in AP-mode.
2142  *	This attribute holds a bitmap of the supported protocols for
2143  *	offloading (see &enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr).
2144  *
2145  * @NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response template data. Contains the entire
2146  *	probe-response frame. The DA field in the 802.11 header is zero-ed out,
2147  *	to be filled by the FW.
2148  * @NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HT: Force HT capable interfaces to disable
2149  *      this feature during association. This is a flag attribute.
2150  *	Currently only supported in mac80211 drivers.
2151  * @NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_VHT: Force VHT capable interfaces to disable
2152  *      this feature during association. This is a flag attribute.
2153  *	Currently only supported in mac80211 drivers.
2154  * @NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HE: Force HE capable interfaces to disable
2155  *      this feature during association. This is a flag attribute.
2156  *	Currently only supported in mac80211 drivers.
2157  * @NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_EHT: Force EHT capable interfaces to disable
2158  *      this feature during association. This is a flag attribute.
2159  *	Currently only supported in mac80211 drivers.
2160  * @NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY_MASK: Specify which bits of the
2161  *      ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY to which attention should be paid.
2162  *      Currently, only mac80211 NICs support this feature.
2163  *      The values that may be configured are:
2164  *       MCS rates, MAX-AMSDU, HT-20-40 and HT_CAP_SGI_40
2165  *       AMPDU density and AMPDU factor.
2166  *      All values are treated as suggestions and may be ignored
2167  *      by the driver as required.  The actual values may be seen in
2168  *      the station debugfs ht_caps file.
2169  * @NL80211_ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY_MASK: Specify which bits of the
2170  *      ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY to which attention should be paid.
2171  *      Currently, only mac80211 NICs support this feature.
2172  *      All values are treated as suggestions and may be ignored
2173  *      by the driver as required.  The actual values may be seen in
2174  *      the station debugfs vht_caps file.
2175  *
2176  * @NL80211_ATTR_DFS_REGION: region for regulatory rules which this country
2177  *    abides to when initiating radiation on DFS channels. A country maps
2178  *    to one DFS region.
2179  *
2180  * @NL80211_ATTR_NOACK_MAP: This u16 bitmap contains the No Ack Policy of
2181  *      up to 16 TIDs.
2182  *
2183  * @NL80211_ATTR_INACTIVITY_TIMEOUT: timeout value in seconds, this can be
2184  *	used by the drivers which has MLME in firmware and does not have support
2185  *	to report per station tx/rx activity to free up the station entry from
2186  *	the list. This needs to be used when the driver advertises the
2187  *	capability to timeout the stations.
2188  *
2189  * @NL80211_ATTR_RX_SIGNAL_DBM: signal strength in dBm (as a 32-bit int);
2190  *	this attribute is (depending on the driver capabilities) added to
2191  *	received frames indicated with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME.
2192  *
2193  * @NL80211_ATTR_BG_SCAN_PERIOD: Background scan period in seconds
2194  *      or 0 to disable background scan.
2195  *
2196  * @NL80211_ATTR_USER_REG_HINT_TYPE: type of regulatory hint passed from
2197  *	userspace. If unset it is assumed the hint comes directly from
2198  *	a user. If set code could specify exactly what type of source
2199  *	was used to provide the hint. For the different types of
2200  *	allowed user regulatory hints see nl80211_user_reg_hint_type.
2201  *
2202  * @NL80211_ATTR_CONN_FAILED_REASON: The reason for which AP has rejected
2203  *	the connection request from a station. nl80211_connect_failed_reason
2204  *	enum has different reasons of connection failure.
2205  *
2206  * @NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_DATA: Fields and elements in Authentication frames.
2207  *	This contains the authentication frame body (non-IE and IE data),
2208  *	excluding the Authentication algorithm number, i.e., starting at the
2209  *	Authentication transaction sequence number field. It is used with
2210  *	authentication algorithms that need special fields to be added into
2211  *	the frames (SAE and FILS). Currently, only the SAE cases use the
2212  *	initial two fields (Authentication transaction sequence number and
2213  *	Status code). However, those fields are included in the attribute data
2214  *	for all authentication algorithms to keep the attribute definition
2215  *	consistent.
2216  *
2217  * @NL80211_ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY: VHT Capability information element (from
2218  *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION)
2219  *
2220  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FLAGS: scan request control flags (u32)
2221  *
2222  * @NL80211_ATTR_P2P_CTWINDOW: P2P GO Client Traffic Window (u8), used with
2223  *	the START_AP and SET_BSS commands
2224  * @NL80211_ATTR_P2P_OPPPS: P2P GO opportunistic PS (u8), used with the
2225  *	START_AP and SET_BSS commands. This can have the values 0 or 1;
2226  *	if not given in START_AP 0 is assumed, if not given in SET_BSS
2227  *	no change is made.
2228  *
2229  * @NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_MESH_POWER_MODE: local mesh STA link-specific power mode
2230  *	defined in &enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode.
2231  *
2232  * @NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY: ACL policy, see &enum nl80211_acl_policy,
2233  *	carried in a u32 attribute
2234  *
2235  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS: Array of nested MAC addresses, used for
2236  *	MAC ACL.
2237  *
2238  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ACL_MAX: u32 attribute to advertise the maximum
2239  *	number of MAC addresses that a device can support for MAC
2240  *	ACL.
2241  *
2242  * @NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT: Type of radar event for notification to userspace,
2243  *	contains a value of enum nl80211_radar_event (u32).
2244  *
2245  * @NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA: 802.11 extended capabilities that the kernel driver
2246  *	has and handles. The format is the same as the IE contents. See
2247  *	802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for more information.
2248  * @NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA_MASK: Extended capabilities that the kernel driver
2249  *	has set in the %NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA value, for multibit fields.
2250  *
2251  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_CAPABILITY: Station capabilities (u16) are advertised to
2252  *	the driver, e.g., to enable TDLS power save (PU-APSD).
2253  *
2254  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_EXT_CAPABILITY: Station extended capabilities are
2255  *	advertised to the driver, e.g., to enable TDLS off channel operations
2256  *	and PU-APSD.
2257  *
2258  * @NL80211_ATTR_PROTOCOL_FEATURES: global nl80211 feature flags, see
2259  *	&enum nl80211_protocol_features, the attribute is a u32.
2260  *
2261  * @NL80211_ATTR_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP: flag attribute, userspace supports
2262  *	receiving the data for a single wiphy split across multiple
2263  *	messages, given with wiphy dump message
2264  *
2265  * @NL80211_ATTR_MDID: Mobility Domain Identifier
2266  *
2267  * @NL80211_ATTR_IE_RIC: Resource Information Container Information
2268  *	Element
2269  *
2270  * @NL80211_ATTR_CRIT_PROT_ID: critical protocol identifier requiring increased
2271  *	reliability, see &enum nl80211_crit_proto_id (u16).
2272  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CRIT_PROT_DURATION: duration in milliseconds in which
2273  *      the connection should have increased reliability (u16).
2274  *
2275  * @NL80211_ATTR_PEER_AID: Association ID for the peer TDLS station (u16).
2276  *	This is similar to @NL80211_ATTR_STA_AID but with a difference of being
2277  *	allowed to be used with the first @NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION command to
2278  *	update a TDLS peer STA entry.
2279  *
2280  * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE: Coalesce rule information.
2281  *
2282  * @NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT: u32 attribute specifying the number of TBTT's
2283  *	until the channel switch event.
2284  * @NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_BLOCK_TX: flag attribute specifying that transmission
2285  *	must be blocked on the current channel (before the channel switch
2286  *	operation). Also included in the channel switch started event if quiet
2287  *	was requested by the AP.
2288  * @NL80211_ATTR_CSA_IES: Nested set of attributes containing the IE information
2289  *	for the time while performing a channel switch.
2290  * @NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_BEACON: An array of offsets (u16) to the channel
2291  *	switch or color change counters in the beacons tail (%NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL).
2292  * @NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_PRESP: An array of offsets (u16) to the channel
2293  *	switch or color change counters in the probe response (%NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP).
2294  *
2295  * @NL80211_ATTR_RXMGMT_FLAGS: flags for nl80211_send_mgmt(), u32.
2296  *	As specified in the &enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags.
2297  *
2298  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_CHANNELS: array of supported channels.
2299  *
2300  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_OPER_CLASSES: array of supported
2301  *      operating classes.
2302  *
2303  * @NL80211_ATTR_HANDLE_DFS: A flag indicating whether user space
2304  *	controls DFS operation in IBSS mode. If the flag is included in
2305  *	%NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS request, the driver will allow use of DFS
2306  *	channels and reports radar events to userspace. Userspace is required
2307  *	to react to radar events, e.g. initiate a channel switch or leave the
2308  *	IBSS network.
2309  *
2310  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_5_MHZ: A flag indicating that the device supports
2311  *	5 MHz channel bandwidth.
2312  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_10_MHZ: A flag indicating that the device supports
2313  *	10 MHz channel bandwidth.
2314  *
2315  * @NL80211_ATTR_OPMODE_NOTIF: Operating mode field from Operating Mode
2316  *	Notification Element based on association request when used with
2317  *	%NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION or %NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION (only when
2318  *	%NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE is supported, or with TDLS);
2319  *	u8 attribute.
2320  *
2321  * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_ID: The vendor ID, either a 24-bit OUI or, if
2322  *	%NL80211_VENDOR_ID_IS_LINUX is set, a special Linux ID (not used yet)
2323  * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_SUBCMD: vendor sub-command
2324  * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA: data for the vendor command, if any; this
2325  *	attribute is also used for vendor command feature advertisement
2326  * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_EVENTS: used for event list advertising in the wiphy
2327  *	info, containing a nested array of possible events
2328  *
2329  * @NL80211_ATTR_QOS_MAP: IP DSCP mapping for Interworking QoS mapping. This
2330  *	data is in the format defined for the payload of the QoS Map Set element
2331  *	in IEEE Std 802.11-2012, 8.4.2.97.
2332  *
2333  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT: MAC address recommendation as initial BSS
2334  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT: frequency of the recommended initial BSS
2335  *
2336  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_AP_ASSOC_STA: Device attribute that indicates how many
2337  *	associated stations are supported in AP mode (including P2P GO); u32.
2338  *	Since drivers may not have a fixed limit on the maximum number (e.g.,
2339  *	other concurrent operations may affect this), drivers are allowed to
2340  *	advertise values that cannot always be met. In such cases, an attempt
2341  *	to add a new station entry with @NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION may fail.
2342  *
2343  * @NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFFSETS_TX: An array of csa counter offsets (u16) which
2344  *	should be updated when the frame is transmitted.
2345  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CSA_COUNTERS: U8 attribute used to advertise the maximum
2346  *	supported number of csa counters.
2347  *
2348  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_PEER_CAPABILITY: flags for TDLS peer capabilities, u32.
2349  *	As specified in the &enum nl80211_tdls_peer_capability.
2350  *
2351  * @NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER: Flag attribute, if set during interface
2352  *	creation then the new interface will be owned by the netlink socket
2353  *	that created it and will be destroyed when the socket is closed.
2354  *	If set during scheduled scan start then the new scan req will be
2355  *	owned by the netlink socket that created it and the scheduled scan will
2356  *	be stopped when the socket is closed.
2357  *	If set during configuration of regulatory indoor operation then the
2358  *	regulatory indoor configuration would be owned by the netlink socket
2359  *	that configured the indoor setting, and the indoor operation would be
2360  *	cleared when the socket is closed.
2361  *	If set during NAN interface creation, the interface will be destroyed
2362  *	if the socket is closed just like any other interface. Moreover, NAN
2363  *	notifications will be sent in unicast to that socket. Without this
2364  *	attribute, the notifications will be sent to the %NL80211_MCGRP_NAN
2365  *	multicast group.
2366  *	If set during %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE or %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT the
2367  *	station will deauthenticate when the socket is closed.
2368  *	If set during %NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS the IBSS will be automatically
2369  *	torn down when the socket is closed.
2370  *	If set during %NL80211_CMD_JOIN_MESH the mesh setup will be
2371  *	automatically torn down when the socket is closed.
2372  *	If set during %NL80211_CMD_START_AP the AP will be automatically
2373  *	disabled when the socket is closed.
2374  *
2375  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_INITIATOR: flag attribute indicating the current end is
2376  *	the TDLS link initiator.
2377  *
2378  * @NL80211_ATTR_USE_RRM: flag for indicating whether the current connection
2379  *	shall support Radio Resource Measurements (11k). This attribute can be
2380  *	used with %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT requests.
2381  *	User space applications are expected to use this flag only if the
2382  *	underlying device supports these minimal RRM features:
2383  *		%NL80211_FEATURE_DS_PARAM_SET_IE_IN_PROBES,
2384  *		%NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET,
2385  *	Or, if global RRM is supported, see:
2386  *		%NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RRM
2387  *	If this flag is used, driver must add the Power Capabilities IE to the
2388  *	association request. In addition, it must also set the RRM capability
2389  *	flag in the association request's Capability Info field.
2390  *
2391  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_DYN_ACK: flag attribute used to enable ACK timeout
2392  *	estimation algorithm (dynack). In order to activate dynack
2393  *	%NL80211_FEATURE_ACKTO_ESTIMATION feature flag must be set by lower
2394  *	drivers to indicate dynack capability. Dynack is automatically disabled
2395  *	setting valid value for coverage class.
2396  *
2397  * @NL80211_ATTR_TSID: a TSID value (u8 attribute)
2398  * @NL80211_ATTR_USER_PRIO: user priority value (u8 attribute)
2399  * @NL80211_ATTR_ADMITTED_TIME: admitted time in units of 32 microseconds
2400  *	(per second) (u16 attribute)
2401  *
2402  * @NL80211_ATTR_SMPS_MODE: SMPS mode to use (ap mode). see
2403  *	&enum nl80211_smps_mode.
2404  *
2405  * @NL80211_ATTR_OPER_CLASS: operating class
2406  *
2407  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK: MAC address mask
2408  *
2409  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED_REG: flag attribute indicating this device
2410  *	is self-managing its regulatory information and any regulatory domain
2411  *	obtained from it is coming from the device's wiphy and not the global
2412  *	cfg80211 regdomain.
2413  *
2414  * @NL80211_ATTR_EXT_FEATURES: extended feature flags contained in a byte
2415  *	array. The feature flags are identified by their bit index (see &enum
2416  *	nl80211_ext_feature_index). The bit index is ordered starting at the
2417  *	least-significant bit of the first byte in the array, ie. bit index 0
2418  *	is located at bit 0 of byte 0. bit index 25 would be located at bit 1
2419  *	of byte 3 (u8 array).
2420  *
2421  * @NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_RADIO_STATS: Request overall radio statistics to be
2422  *	returned along with other survey data. If set, @NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY
2423  *	may return a survey entry without a channel indicating global radio
2424  *	statistics (only some values are valid and make sense.)
2425  *	For devices that don't return such an entry even then, the information
2426  *	should be contained in the result as the sum of the respective counters
2427  *	over all channels.
2428  *
2429  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_DELAY: delay before the first cycle of a
2430  *	scheduled scan is started.  Or the delay before a WoWLAN
2431  *	net-detect scan is started, counting from the moment the
2432  *	system is suspended.  This value is a u32, in seconds.
2433  *
2434  * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_INDOOR: flag attribute, if set indicates that the device
2435  *      is operating in an indoor environment.
2436  *
2437  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS: maximum number of scan plans for
2438  *	scheduled scan supported by the device (u32), a wiphy attribute.
2439  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL: maximum interval (in seconds) for
2440  *	a scan plan (u32), a wiphy attribute.
2441  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS: maximum number of iterations in
2442  *	a scan plan (u32), a wiphy attribute.
2443  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS: a list of scan plans for scheduled scan.
2444  *	Each scan plan defines the number of scan iterations and the interval
2445  *	between scans. The last scan plan will always run infinitely,
2446  *	thus it must not specify the number of iterations, only the interval
2447  *	between scans. The scan plans are executed sequentially.
2448  *	Each scan plan is a nested attribute of &enum nl80211_sched_scan_plan.
2449  * @NL80211_ATTR_PBSS: flag attribute. If set it means operate
2450  *	in a PBSS. Specified in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to request
2451  *	connecting to a PCP, and in %NL80211_CMD_START_AP to start
2452  *	a PCP instead of AP. Relevant for DMG networks only.
2453  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SELECT: nested attribute for driver supporting the
2454  *	BSS selection feature. When used with %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY it contains
2455  *	attributes according &enum nl80211_bss_select_attr to indicate what
2456  *	BSS selection behaviours are supported. When used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT
2457  *	it contains the behaviour-specific attribute containing the parameters for
2458  *	BSS selection to be done by driver and/or firmware.
2459  *
2460  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORT_P2P_PS: whether P2P PS mechanism supported
2461  *	or not. u8, one of the values of &enum nl80211_sta_p2p_ps_status
2462  *
2463  * @NL80211_ATTR_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
2464  *
2465  * @NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_EXT_CAPA: Nested attribute of the following attributes:
2466  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE, %NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA,
2467  *	%NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA_MASK, to specify the extended capabilities and
2468  *	other interface-type specific capabilities per interface type. For MLO,
2469  *	%NL80211_ATTR_EML_CAPABILITY and %NL80211_ATTR_MLD_CAPA_AND_OPS are
2470  *	present.
2471  *
2472  * @NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_GROUP_DATA: array of 24 bytes that defines a MU-MIMO
2473  *	groupID for monitor mode.
2474  *	The first 8 bytes are a mask that defines the membership in each
2475  *	group (there are 64 groups, group 0 and 63 are reserved),
2476  *	each bit represents a group and set to 1 for being a member in
2477  *	that group and 0 for not being a member.
2478  *	The remaining 16 bytes define the position in each group: 2 bits for
2479  *	each group.
2480  *	(smaller group numbers represented on most significant bits and bigger
2481  *	group numbers on least significant bits.)
2482  *	This attribute is used only if all interfaces are in monitor mode.
2483  *	Set this attribute in order to monitor packets using the given MU-MIMO
2484  *	groupID data.
2485  *	to turn off that feature set all the bits of the groupID to zero.
2486  * @NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_FOLLOW_MAC_ADDR: mac address for the sniffer to follow
2487  *	when using MU-MIMO air sniffer.
2488  *	to turn that feature off set an invalid mac address
2489  *	(e.g. FF:FF:FF:FF:FF:FF)
2490  *
2491  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF: The time at which the scan was actually
2492  *	started (u64). The time is the TSF of the BSS the interface that
2493  *	requested the scan is connected to (if available, otherwise this
2494  *	attribute must not be included).
2495  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF_BSSID: The BSS according to which
2496  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF is set.
2497  * @NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION: measurement duration in TUs (u16). If
2498  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION_MANDATORY is not set, this is the
2499  *	maximum measurement duration allowed. This attribute is used with
2500  *	measurement requests. It can also be used with %NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN
2501  *	if the scan is used for beacon report radio measurement.
2502  * @NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION_MANDATORY: flag attribute that indicates
2503  *	that the duration specified with %NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION is
2504  *	mandatory. If this flag is not set, the duration is the maximum duration
2505  *	and the actual measurement duration may be shorter.
2506  *
2507  * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_PEER_AID: Association ID for the mesh peer (u16). This is
2508  *	used to pull the stored data for mesh peer in power save state.
2509  *
2510  * @NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF: the master preference to be used by
2511  *	%NL80211_CMD_START_NAN and optionally with
2512  *	%NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG. Its type is u8 and it can't be 0.
2513  *	Also, values 1 and 255 are reserved for certification purposes and
2514  *	should not be used during a normal device operation.
2515  * @NL80211_ATTR_BANDS: operating bands configuration.  This is a u32
2516  *	bitmask of BIT(NL80211_BAND_*) as described in %enum
2517  *	nl80211_band.  For instance, for NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0
2518  *	would be set.  This attribute is used with
2519  *	%NL80211_CMD_START_NAN and %NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG, and
2520  *	it is optional.  If no bands are set, it means don't-care and
2521  *	the device will decide what to use.
2522  * @NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC: a function that can be added to NAN. See
2523  *	&enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes for description of this nested
2524  *	attribute.
2525  * @NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MATCH: used to report a match. This is a nested attribute.
2526  *	See &enum nl80211_nan_match_attributes.
2527  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK: KEK for FILS (Re)Association Request/Response frame
2528  *	protection.
2529  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES: Nonces (part of AAD) for FILS (Re)Association
2530  *	Request/Response frame protection. This attribute contains the 16 octet
2531  *	STA Nonce followed by 16 octets of AP Nonce.
2532  *
2533  * @NL80211_ATTR_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST_ENABLED: Indicates whether or not multicast
2534  *	packets should be send out as unicast to all stations (flag attribute).
2535  *
2536  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSSID: The BSSID of the AP. Note that %NL80211_ATTR_MAC is also
2537  *	used in various commands/events for specifying the BSSID.
2538  *
2539  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI: Relative RSSI threshold by which
2540  *	other BSSs has to be better or slightly worse than the current
2541  *	connected BSS so that they get reported to user space.
2542  *	This will give an opportunity to userspace to consider connecting to
2543  *	other matching BSSs which have better or slightly worse RSSI than
2544  *	the current connected BSS by using an offloaded operation to avoid
2545  *	unnecessary wakeups.
2546  *
2547  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RSSI_ADJUST: When present the RSSI level for BSSs in
2548  *	the specified band is to be adjusted before doing
2549  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI based comparison to figure out
2550  *	better BSSs. The attribute value is a packed structure
2551  *	value as specified by &struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust.
2552  *
2553  * @NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT_REASON: The reason for which an operation timed out.
2554  *	u32 attribute with an &enum nl80211_timeout_reason value. This is used,
2555  *	e.g., with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT event.
2556  *
2557  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME: EAP Re-authentication Protocol (ERP)
2558  *	username part of NAI used to refer keys rRK and rIK. This is used with
2559  *	%NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2560  *
2561  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM: EAP Re-authentication Protocol (ERP) realm part
2562  *	of NAI specifying the domain name of the ER server. This is used with
2563  *	%NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2564  *
2565  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM: Unsigned 16-bit ERP next sequence number
2566  *	to use in ERP messages. This is used in generating the FILS wrapped data
2567  *	for FILS authentication and is used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2568  *
2569  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_RRK: ERP re-authentication Root Key (rRK) for the
2570  *	NAI specified by %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME and
2571  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM. This is used for generating rIK and rMSK
2572  *	from successful FILS authentication and is used with
2573  *	%NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2574  *
2575  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID: A 2-octet identifier advertised by a FILS AP
2576  *	identifying the scope of PMKSAs. This is used with
2577  *	@NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA and @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA.
2578  *
2579  * @NL80211_ATTR_PMK: attribute for passing PMK key material. Used with
2580  *	%NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA for the PMKSA identified by %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID.
2581  *	For %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and %NL80211_CMD_START_AP it is used to provide
2582  *	PSK for offloading 4-way handshake for WPA/WPA2-PSK networks. For 802.1X
2583  *	authentication it is used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK. For offloaded FT
2584  *	support this attribute specifies the PMK-R0 if NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME
2585  *	is included as well.
2586  *
2587  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MULTI: flag attribute which user-space shall use to
2588  *	indicate that it supports multiple active scheduled scan requests.
2589  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MAX_REQS: indicates maximum number of scheduled
2590  *	scan request that may be active for the device (u32).
2591  *
2592  * @NL80211_ATTR_WANT_1X_4WAY_HS: flag attribute which user-space can include
2593  *	in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to indicate that for 802.1X authentication it
2594  *	wants to use the supported offload of the 4-way handshake.
2595  * @NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME: PMK-R0 Name for offloaded FT.
2596  * @NL80211_ATTR_PORT_AUTHORIZED: (reserved)
2597  *
2598  * @NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ACTION: Identify the requested external
2599  *     authentication operation (u32 attribute with an
2600  *     &enum nl80211_external_auth_action value). This is used with the
2601  *     %NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH request event.
2602  * @NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: Flag attribute indicating that the user
2603  *	space supports external authentication. This attribute shall be used
2604  *	with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and %NL80211_CMD_START_AP request. The driver
2605  *	may offload authentication processing to user space if this capability
2606  *	is indicated in the respective requests from the user space. (This flag
2607  *	attribute deprecated for %NL80211_CMD_START_AP, use
2608  *	%NL80211_ATTR_AP_SETTINGS_FLAGS)
2609  *
2610  * @NL80211_ATTR_NSS: Station's New/updated  RX_NSS value notified using this
2611  *	u8 attribute. This is used with %NL80211_CMD_STA_OPMODE_CHANGED.
2612  *
2613  * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_STATS: TXQ statistics (nested attribute, see &enum
2614  *      nl80211_txq_stats)
2615  * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_LIMIT: Total packet limit for the TXQ queues for this phy.
2616  *      The smaller of this and the memory limit is enforced.
2617  * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT: Total memory limit (in bytes) for the
2618  *      TXQ queues for this phy. The smaller of this and the packet limit is
2619  *      enforced.
2620  * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_QUANTUM: TXQ scheduler quantum (bytes). Number of bytes
2621  *      a flow is assigned on each round of the DRR scheduler.
2622  * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_CAPABILITY: HE Capability information element (from
2623  *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION). Can be set
2624  *	only if %NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME is set.
2625  *
2626  * @NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER: nested attribute which user-space can include
2627  *	in %NL80211_CMD_START_AP or %NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON for fine timing
2628  *	measurement (FTM) responder functionality and containing parameters as
2629  *	possible, see &enum nl80211_ftm_responder_attr
2630  *
2631  * @NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS: Nested attribute with FTM responder
2632  *	statistics, see &enum nl80211_ftm_responder_stats.
2633  *
2634  * @NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT: Timeout for the given operation in milliseconds (u32),
2635  *	if the attribute is not given no timeout is requested. Note that 0 is an
2636  *	invalid value.
2637  *
2638  * @NL80211_ATTR_PEER_MEASUREMENTS: peer measurements request (and result)
2639  *	data, uses nested attributes specified in
2640  *	&enum nl80211_peer_measurement_attrs.
2641  *	This is also used for capability advertisement in the wiphy information,
2642  *	with the appropriate sub-attributes.
2643  *
2644  * @NL80211_ATTR_AIRTIME_WEIGHT: Station's weight when scheduled by the airtime
2645  *	scheduler.
2646  *
2647  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER_SETTING: Transmit power setting type (u8) for
2648  *	station associated with the AP. See &enum nl80211_tx_power_setting for
2649  *	possible values.
2650  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER: Transmit power level (s16) in dBm units. This
2651  *	allows to set Tx power for a station. If this attribute is not included,
2652  *	the default per-interface tx power setting will be overriding. Driver
2653  *	should be picking up the lowest tx power, either tx power per-interface
2654  *	or per-station.
2655  *
2656  * @NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PASSWORD: attribute for passing SAE password material. It
2657  *	is used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to provide password for offloading
2658  *	SAE authentication for WPA3-Personal networks.
2659  *
2660  * @NL80211_ATTR_TWT_RESPONDER: Enable target wait time responder support.
2661  *
2662  * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_OBSS_PD: nested attribute for OBSS Packet Detection
2663  *	functionality.
2664  *
2665  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_CHANNELS: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz
2666  *	channel(s) that are allowed to be used for EDMG transmissions.
2667  *	Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251. (u8 attribute)
2668  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_BW_CONFIG: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes
2669  *	the allowed channel bandwidth configurations. (u8 attribute)
2670  *	Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251, Table 13.
2671  *
2672  * @NL80211_ATTR_VLAN_ID: VLAN ID (1..4094) for the station and VLAN group key
2673  *	(u16).
2674  *
2675  * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_BSS_COLOR: nested attribute for BSS Color Settings.
2676  *
2677  * @NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_AKM_SUITES: nested array attribute, with each entry
2678  *	using attributes from &enum nl80211_iftype_akm_attributes. This
2679  *	attribute is sent in a response to %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY indicating
2680  *	supported AKM suites capability per interface. AKMs advertised in
2681  *	%NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES are default capabilities if AKM suites not
2682  *	advertised for a specific interface type.
2683  *
2684  * @NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG: TID specific configuration in a
2685  *	nested attribute with &enum nl80211_tid_config_attr sub-attributes;
2686  *	on output (in wiphy attributes) it contains only the feature sub-
2687  *	attributes.
2688  *
2689  * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH: disable preauth frame rx on control
2690  *	port in order to forward/receive them as ordinary data frames.
2691  *
2692  * @NL80211_ATTR_PMK_LIFETIME: Maximum lifetime for PMKSA in seconds (u32,
2693  *	dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold; 0 is not a valid value).
2694  *	An optional parameter configured through %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA.
2695  *	Drivers that trigger roaming need to know the lifetime of the
2696  *	configured PMKSA for triggering the full vs. PMKSA caching based
2697  *	authentication. This timeout helps authentication methods like SAE,
2698  *	where PMK gets updated only by going through a full (new SAE)
2699  *	authentication instead of getting updated during an association for EAP
2700  *	authentication. No new full authentication within the PMK expiry shall
2701  *	result in a disassociation at the end of the lifetime.
2702  *
2703  * @NL80211_ATTR_PMK_REAUTH_THRESHOLD: Reauthentication threshold time, in
2704  *	terms of percentage of %NL80211_ATTR_PMK_LIFETIME
2705  *	(u8, dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold, 1..100). This is an optional
2706  *	parameter configured through %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA. Requests the
2707  *	driver to trigger a full authentication roam (without PMKSA caching)
2708  *	after the reauthentication threshold time, but before the PMK lifetime
2709  *	has expired.
2710  *
2711  *	Authentication methods like SAE need to be able to generate a new PMKSA
2712  *	entry without having to force a disconnection after the PMK timeout. If
2713  *	no roaming occurs between the reauth threshold and PMK expiration,
2714  *	disassociation is still forced.
2715  * @NL80211_ATTR_RECEIVE_MULTICAST: multicast flag for the
2716  *	%NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME command, see the description there.
2717  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET: offset of the associated
2718  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ in positive KHz. Only valid when supplied with
2719  *	an %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET.
2720  * @NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1_OFFSET: Center frequency offset in KHz for the
2721  *	first channel segment specified in %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1.
2722  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ: nested attribute with KHz frequencies
2723  *
2724  * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPABILITY: HE 6 GHz Band Capability element (from
2725  *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION).
2726  *
2727  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_DISCOVERY: Optional parameter to configure FILS
2728  *	discovery. It is a nested attribute, see
2729  *	&enum nl80211_fils_discovery_attributes. Userspace should pass an empty
2730  *	nested attribute to disable this feature and delete the templates.
2731  *
2732  * @NL80211_ATTR_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Optional parameter to configure
2733  *	unsolicited broadcast probe response. It is a nested attribute, see
2734  *	&enum nl80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_attributes. Userspace should pass an empty
2735  *	nested attribute to disable this feature and delete the templates.
2736  *
2737  * @NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY: S1G Capability information element (from
2738  *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION)
2739  * @NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY_MASK: S1G Capability Information element
2740  *	override mask. Used with NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY in
2741  *	NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE or NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2742  *
2743  * @NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PWE: Indicates the mechanism(s) allowed for SAE PWE
2744  *	derivation in WPA3-Personal networks which are using SAE authentication.
2745  *	This is a u8 attribute that encapsulates one of the values from
2746  *	&enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism.
2747  *
2748  * @NL80211_ATTR_SAR_SPEC: SAR power limitation specification when
2749  *	used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_SAR_SPECS. The message contains fields
2750  *	of %nl80211_sar_attrs which specifies the sar type and related
2751  *	sar specs. Sar specs contains array of %nl80211_sar_specs_attrs.
2752  *
2753  * @NL80211_ATTR_RECONNECT_REQUESTED: flag attribute, used with deauth and
2754  *	disassoc events to indicate that an immediate reconnect to the AP
2755  *	is desired.
2756  *
2757  * @NL80211_ATTR_OBSS_COLOR_BITMAP: bitmap of the u64 BSS colors for the
2758  *	%NL80211_CMD_OBSS_COLOR_COLLISION event.
2759  *
2760  * @NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_COUNT: u8 attribute specifying the number of TBTT's
2761  *	until the color switch event.
2762  * @NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_COLOR: u8 attribute specifying the color that we are
2763  *	switching to
2764  * @NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_ELEMS: Nested set of attributes containing the IE
2765  *	information for the time while performing a color switch.
2766  *
2767  * @NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_CONFIG: Nested attribute for multiple BSSID
2768  *	advertisements (MBSSID) parameters in AP mode.
2769  *	Kernel uses this attribute to indicate the driver's support for MBSSID
2770  *	and enhanced multi-BSSID advertisements (EMA AP) to the userspace.
2771  *	Userspace should use this attribute to configure per interface MBSSID
2772  *	parameters.
2773  *	See &enum nl80211_mbssid_config_attributes for details.
2774  *
2775  * @NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_ELEMS: Nested parameter to pass multiple BSSID elements.
2776  *	Mandatory parameter for the transmitting interface to enable MBSSID.
2777  *	Optional for the non-transmitting interfaces.
2778  *
2779  * @NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_BACKGROUND: Configure dedicated offchannel chain
2780  *	available for radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used
2781  *	to transmit or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev.
2782  *	Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime
2783  *	switching on a different channel during CAC detection on the selected
2784  *	radar channel.
2785  *
2786  * @NL80211_ATTR_AP_SETTINGS_FLAGS: u32 attribute contains ap settings flags,
2787  *	enumerated in &enum nl80211_ap_settings_flags. This attribute shall be
2788  *	used with %NL80211_CMD_START_AP request.
2789  *
2790  * @NL80211_ATTR_EHT_CAPABILITY: EHT Capability information element (from
2791  *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION). Can be set
2792  *	only if %NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME is set.
2793  *
2794  * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID: A (u8) link ID for use with MLO, to be used with
2795  *	various commands that need a link ID to operate.
2796  * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINKS: A nested array of links, each containing some
2797  *	per-link information and a link ID.
2798  * @NL80211_ATTR_MLD_ADDR: An MLD address, used with various commands such as
2799  *	authenticate/associate.
2800  *
2801  * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_SUPPORT: Flag attribute to indicate user space supports MLO
2802  *	connection. Used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT. If this attribute is not
2803  *	included in NL80211_CMD_CONNECT drivers must not perform MLO connection.
2804  *
2805  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES: U16 attribute. Indicates maximum number of
2806  *	AKM suites allowed for %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT, %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and
2807  *	%NL80211_CMD_START_AP in %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY response. If this
2808  *	attribute is not present userspace shall consider maximum number of AKM
2809  *	suites allowed as %NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES which is the legacy maximum
2810  *	number prior to the introduction of this attribute.
2811  *
2812  * @NL80211_ATTR_EML_CAPABILITY: EML Capability information (u16)
2813  * @NL80211_ATTR_MLD_CAPA_AND_OPS: MLD Capabilities and Operations (u16)
2814  *
2815  * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_HW_TIMESTAMP: Hardware timestamp for TX operation in
2816  *	nanoseconds (u64). This is the device clock timestamp so it will
2817  *	probably reset when the device is stopped or the firmware is reset.
2818  *	When used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS, indicates the frame TX
2819  *	timestamp. When used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME RX notification, indicates
2820  *	the ack TX timestamp.
2821  * @NL80211_ATTR_RX_HW_TIMESTAMP: Hardware timestamp for RX operation in
2822  *	nanoseconds (u64). This is the device clock timestamp so it will
2823  *	probably reset when the device is stopped or the firmware is reset.
2824  *	When used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS, indicates the ack RX
2825  *	timestamp. When used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME RX notification, indicates
2826  *	the incoming frame RX timestamp.
2827  * @NL80211_ATTR_TD_BITMAP: Transition Disable bitmap, for subsequent
2828  *	(re)associations.
2829  *
2830  * @NL80211_ATTR_PUNCT_BITMAP: (u32) Preamble puncturing bitmap, lowest
2831  *	bit corresponds to the lowest 20 MHz channel. Each bit set to 1
2832  *	indicates that the sub-channel is punctured. Higher 16 bits are
2833  *	reserved.
2834  *
2835  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_HW_TIMESTAMP_PEERS: Maximum number of peers that HW
2836  *	timestamping can be enabled for concurrently (u16), a wiphy attribute.
2837  *	A value of 0xffff indicates setting for all peers (i.e. not specifying
2838  *	an address with %NL80211_CMD_SET_HW_TIMESTAMP) is supported.
2839  * @NL80211_ATTR_HW_TIMESTAMP_ENABLED: Indicates whether HW timestamping should
2840  *	be enabled or not (flag attribute).
2841  *
2842  * @NL80211_ATTR_EMA_RNR_ELEMS: Optional nested attribute for
2843  *	reduced neighbor report (RNR) elements. This attribute can be used
2844  *	only when NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_EMA is enabled.
2845  *	Userspace is responsible for splitting the RNR into multiple
2846  *	elements such that each element excludes the non-transmitting
2847  *	profiles already included in the MBSSID element
2848  *	(%NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_ELEMS) at the same index. Each EMA beacon
2849  *	will be generated by adding MBSSID and RNR elements at the same
2850  *	index. If the userspace includes more RNR elements than number of
2851  *	MBSSID elements then these will be added in every EMA beacon.
2852  *
2853  * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_DISABLED: Flag attribute indicating that the link is
2854  *	disabled.
2855  *
2856  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_DUMP_INCLUDE_USE_DATA: Include BSS usage data, i.e.
2857  *	include BSSes that can only be used in restricted scenarios and/or
2858  *	cannot be used at all.
2859  *
2860  * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_TTLM_DLINK: Binary attribute specifying the downlink TID to
2861  *      link mapping. The length is 8 * sizeof(u16). For each TID the link
2862  *      mapping is as defined in section 9.4.2.314 (TID-To-Link Mapping element)
2863  *      in Draft P802.11be_D4.0.
2864  * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_TTLM_ULINK: Binary attribute specifying the uplink TID to
2865  *      link mapping. The length is 8 * sizeof(u16). For each TID the link
2866  *      mapping is as defined in section 9.4.2.314 (TID-To-Link Mapping element)
2867  *      in Draft P802.11be_D4.0.
2868  *
2869  * @NL80211_ATTR_ASSOC_SPP_AMSDU: flag attribute used with
2870  *	%NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE indicating the SPP A-MSDUs
2871  *	are used on this connection
2872  *
2873  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RADIOS: Nested attribute describing physical radios
2874  *	belonging to this wiphy. See &enum nl80211_wiphy_radio_attrs.
2875  *
2876  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS: Nested attribute listing the
2877  *	supported interface combinations for all radios combined. In each
2878  *	nested item, it contains attributes defined in
2879  *	&enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs.
2880  *
2881  * @NL80211_ATTR_VIF_RADIO_MASK: Bitmask of allowed radios (u32).
2882  *	A value of 0 means all radios.
2883  *
2884  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_SELECTORS: supported BSS Membership Selectors, array
2885  *	of supported selectors as defined by IEEE Std 802.11-2020 9.4.2.3 but
2886  *	without the length restriction (at most %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_SELECTORS).
2887  *	This can be used to provide a list of selectors that are implemented
2888  *	by the supplicant. If not given, support for SAE_H2E is assumed.
2889  *
2890  * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_RECONF_REM_LINKS: (u16) A bitmask of the links requested
2891  *      to be removed from the MLO association.
2892  *
2893  * @NL80211_ATTR_EPCS: Flag attribute indicating that EPCS is enabled for a
2894  *	station interface.
2895  *
2896  * @NL80211_ATTR_ASSOC_MLD_EXT_CAPA_OPS: Extended MLD capabilities and
2897  *	operations that userspace implements to use during association/ML
2898  *	link reconfig, currently only "BTM MLD Recommendation For Multiple
2899  *	APs Support". Drivers may set additional flags that they support
2900  *	in the kernel or device.
2901  *
2902  * @NUM_NL80211_ATTR: total number of nl80211_attrs available
2903  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number currently defined
2904  * @__NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
2905  */
2906 enum nl80211_attrs {
2907 /* don't change the order or add anything between, this is ABI! */
2908 	NL80211_ATTR_UNSPEC,
2909 
2910 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY,
2911 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME,
2912 
2913 	NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX,
2914 	NL80211_ATTR_IFNAME,
2915 	NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE,
2916 
2917 	NL80211_ATTR_MAC,
2918 
2919 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DATA,
2920 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX,
2921 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_CIPHER,
2922 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ,
2923 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT,
2924 
2925 	NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL,
2926 	NL80211_ATTR_DTIM_PERIOD,
2927 	NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_HEAD,
2928 	NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL,
2929 
2930 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_AID,
2931 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS,
2932 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_LISTEN_INTERVAL,
2933 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_RATES,
2934 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_VLAN,
2935 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_INFO,
2936 
2937 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_BANDS,
2938 
2939 	NL80211_ATTR_MNTR_FLAGS,
2940 
2941 	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_ID,
2942 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_ACTION,
2943 	NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_NEXT_HOP,
2944 	NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_INFO,
2945 
2946 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_CTS_PROT,
2947 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_PREAMBLE,
2948 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME,
2949 
2950 	NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY,
2951 
2952 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES,
2953 
2954 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2,
2955 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULES,
2956 
2957 	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_CONFIG,
2958 
2959 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES,
2960 
2961 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS,
2962 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ,
2963 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE,
2964 
2965 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT,
2966 
2967 	NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE,
2968 	NL80211_ATTR_IE,
2969 
2970 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCAN_SSIDS,
2971 
2972 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES,
2973 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS,
2974 	NL80211_ATTR_GENERATION, /* replaces old SCAN_GENERATION */
2975 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS,
2976 
2977 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR,
2978 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE,
2979 
2980 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_COMMANDS,
2981 
2982 	NL80211_ATTR_FRAME,
2983 	NL80211_ATTR_SSID,
2984 	NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE,
2985 	NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE,
2986 
2987 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_TYPE,
2988 
2989 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_IE_LEN,
2990 	NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES,
2991 
2992 	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_BEFORE,
2993 	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_AFTER,
2994 
2995 	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_FIXED,
2996 
2997 
2998 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_SHORT,
2999 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_LONG,
3000 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FRAG_THRESHOLD,
3001 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RTS_THRESHOLD,
3002 
3003 	NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT,
3004 
3005 	NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP,
3006 
3007 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS2,
3008 
3009 	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT,
3010 
3011 	NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA,
3012 
3013 	NL80211_ATTR_PRIVACY,
3014 
3015 	NL80211_ATTR_DISCONNECTED_BY_AP,
3016 	NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE,
3017 
3018 	NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE,
3019 	NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP,
3020 	NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS,
3021 	NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES,
3022 
3023 	NL80211_ATTR_REQ_IE,
3024 	NL80211_ATTR_RESP_IE,
3025 
3026 	NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID,
3027 
3028 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY,
3029 	NL80211_ATTR_KEYS,
3030 
3031 	NL80211_ATTR_PID,
3032 
3033 	NL80211_ATTR_4ADDR,
3034 
3035 	NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_INFO,
3036 
3037 	NL80211_ATTR_PMKID,
3038 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_PMKIDS,
3039 
3040 	NL80211_ATTR_DURATION,
3041 
3042 	NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE,
3043 
3044 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_COVERAGE_CLASS,
3045 
3046 	NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES,
3047 
3048 	NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_MATCH,
3049 
3050 	NL80211_ATTR_ACK,
3051 
3052 	NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE,
3053 
3054 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM,
3055 
3056 	NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_STATE_CHANGE,
3057 
3058 	NL80211_ATTR_AP_ISOLATE,
3059 
3060 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_SETTING,
3061 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_LEVEL,
3062 
3063 	NL80211_ATTR_TX_FRAME_TYPES,
3064 	NL80211_ATTR_RX_FRAME_TYPES,
3065 	NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE,
3066 
3067 	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE,
3068 	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT,
3069 
3070 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_IBSS_RSN,
3071 
3072 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX,
3073 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_RX,
3074 
3075 	NL80211_ATTR_MCAST_RATE,
3076 
3077 	NL80211_ATTR_OFFCHANNEL_TX_OK,
3078 
3079 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_HT_OPMODE,
3080 
3081 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES,
3082 
3083 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL_DURATION,
3084 
3085 	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_SETUP,
3086 
3087 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_TX,
3088 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_RX,
3089 
3090 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_MESH_AUTH,
3091 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_STATE,
3092 
3093 	NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS,
3094 	NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED,
3095 
3096 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL,
3097 
3098 	NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS,
3099 	NL80211_ATTR_SOFTWARE_IFTYPES,
3100 
3101 	NL80211_ATTR_REKEY_DATA,
3102 
3103 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_SSIDS,
3104 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCHED_SCAN_IE_LEN,
3105 
3106 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SUPP_RATES,
3107 
3108 	NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID,
3109 
3110 	NL80211_ATTR_IE_PROBE_RESP,
3111 	NL80211_ATTR_IE_ASSOC_RESP,
3112 
3113 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_WME,
3114 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_AP_UAPSD,
3115 
3116 	NL80211_ATTR_ROAM_SUPPORT,
3117 
3118 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH,
3119 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_MATCH_SETS,
3120 
3121 	NL80211_ATTR_PMKSA_CANDIDATE,
3122 
3123 	NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE,
3124 
3125 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_ACTION,
3126 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_DIALOG_TOKEN,
3127 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION,
3128 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_SUPPORT,
3129 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP,
3130 
3131 	NL80211_ATTR_DEVICE_AP_SME,
3132 
3133 	NL80211_ATTR_DONT_WAIT_FOR_ACK,
3134 
3135 	NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS,
3136 
3137 	NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD,
3138 
3139 	NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP,
3140 
3141 	NL80211_ATTR_DFS_REGION,
3142 
3143 	NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HT,
3144 	NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY_MASK,
3145 
3146 	NL80211_ATTR_NOACK_MAP,
3147 
3148 	NL80211_ATTR_INACTIVITY_TIMEOUT,
3149 
3150 	NL80211_ATTR_RX_SIGNAL_DBM,
3151 
3152 	NL80211_ATTR_BG_SCAN_PERIOD,
3153 
3154 	NL80211_ATTR_WDEV,
3155 
3156 	NL80211_ATTR_USER_REG_HINT_TYPE,
3157 
3158 	NL80211_ATTR_CONN_FAILED_REASON,
3159 
3160 	NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_DATA,
3161 
3162 	NL80211_ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY,
3163 
3164 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FLAGS,
3165 
3166 	NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH,
3167 	NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1,
3168 	NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2,
3169 
3170 	NL80211_ATTR_P2P_CTWINDOW,
3171 	NL80211_ATTR_P2P_OPPPS,
3172 
3173 	NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_MESH_POWER_MODE,
3174 
3175 	NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY,
3176 
3177 	NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS,
3178 
3179 	NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ACL_MAX,
3180 
3181 	NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT,
3182 
3183 	NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA,
3184 	NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA_MASK,
3185 
3186 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_CAPABILITY,
3187 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_EXT_CAPABILITY,
3188 
3189 	NL80211_ATTR_PROTOCOL_FEATURES,
3190 	NL80211_ATTR_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP,
3191 
3192 	NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_VHT,
3193 	NL80211_ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY_MASK,
3194 
3195 	NL80211_ATTR_MDID,
3196 	NL80211_ATTR_IE_RIC,
3197 
3198 	NL80211_ATTR_CRIT_PROT_ID,
3199 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CRIT_PROT_DURATION,
3200 
3201 	NL80211_ATTR_PEER_AID,
3202 
3203 	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE,
3204 
3205 	NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT,
3206 	NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_BLOCK_TX,
3207 	NL80211_ATTR_CSA_IES,
3208 	NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_BEACON,
3209 	NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_PRESP,
3210 
3211 	NL80211_ATTR_RXMGMT_FLAGS,
3212 
3213 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_CHANNELS,
3214 
3215 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_OPER_CLASSES,
3216 
3217 	NL80211_ATTR_HANDLE_DFS,
3218 
3219 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_5_MHZ,
3220 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_10_MHZ,
3221 
3222 	NL80211_ATTR_OPMODE_NOTIF,
3223 
3224 	NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_ID,
3225 	NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_SUBCMD,
3226 	NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA,
3227 	NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_EVENTS,
3228 
3229 	NL80211_ATTR_QOS_MAP,
3230 
3231 	NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT,
3232 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT,
3233 
3234 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_AP_ASSOC_STA,
3235 
3236 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_PEER_CAPABILITY,
3237 
3238 	NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER,
3239 
3240 	NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFFSETS_TX,
3241 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CSA_COUNTERS,
3242 
3243 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_INITIATOR,
3244 
3245 	NL80211_ATTR_USE_RRM,
3246 
3247 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_DYN_ACK,
3248 
3249 	NL80211_ATTR_TSID,
3250 	NL80211_ATTR_USER_PRIO,
3251 	NL80211_ATTR_ADMITTED_TIME,
3252 
3253 	NL80211_ATTR_SMPS_MODE,
3254 
3255 	NL80211_ATTR_OPER_CLASS,
3256 
3257 	NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK,
3258 
3259 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED_REG,
3260 
3261 	NL80211_ATTR_EXT_FEATURES,
3262 
3263 	NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_RADIO_STATS,
3264 
3265 	NL80211_ATTR_NETNS_FD,
3266 
3267 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_DELAY,
3268 
3269 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_INDOOR,
3270 
3271 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS,
3272 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL,
3273 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS,
3274 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS,
3275 
3276 	NL80211_ATTR_PBSS,
3277 
3278 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SELECT,
3279 
3280 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORT_P2P_PS,
3281 
3282 	NL80211_ATTR_PAD,
3283 
3284 	NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_EXT_CAPA,
3285 
3286 	NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_GROUP_DATA,
3287 	NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_FOLLOW_MAC_ADDR,
3288 
3289 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF,
3290 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF_BSSID,
3291 	NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION,
3292 	NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION_MANDATORY,
3293 
3294 	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_PEER_AID,
3295 
3296 	NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF,
3297 	NL80211_ATTR_BANDS,
3298 	NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC,
3299 	NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MATCH,
3300 
3301 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK,
3302 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES,
3303 
3304 	NL80211_ATTR_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST_ENABLED,
3305 
3306 	NL80211_ATTR_BSSID,
3307 
3308 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI,
3309 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RSSI_ADJUST,
3310 
3311 	NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT_REASON,
3312 
3313 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME,
3314 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM,
3315 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM,
3316 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_RRK,
3317 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID,
3318 
3319 	NL80211_ATTR_PMK,
3320 
3321 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MULTI,
3322 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MAX_REQS,
3323 
3324 	NL80211_ATTR_WANT_1X_4WAY_HS,
3325 	NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME,
3326 	NL80211_ATTR_PORT_AUTHORIZED,
3327 
3328 	NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ACTION,
3329 	NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT,
3330 
3331 	NL80211_ATTR_NSS,
3332 	NL80211_ATTR_ACK_SIGNAL,
3333 
3334 	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211,
3335 
3336 	NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_STATS,
3337 	NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_LIMIT,
3338 	NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT,
3339 	NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_QUANTUM,
3340 
3341 	NL80211_ATTR_HE_CAPABILITY,
3342 
3343 	NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER,
3344 
3345 	NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS,
3346 
3347 	NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT,
3348 
3349 	NL80211_ATTR_PEER_MEASUREMENTS,
3350 
3351 	NL80211_ATTR_AIRTIME_WEIGHT,
3352 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER_SETTING,
3353 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER,
3354 
3355 	NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PASSWORD,
3356 
3357 	NL80211_ATTR_TWT_RESPONDER,
3358 
3359 	NL80211_ATTR_HE_OBSS_PD,
3360 
3361 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_CHANNELS,
3362 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_BW_CONFIG,
3363 
3364 	NL80211_ATTR_VLAN_ID,
3365 
3366 	NL80211_ATTR_HE_BSS_COLOR,
3367 
3368 	NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_AKM_SUITES,
3369 
3370 	NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG,
3371 
3372 	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH,
3373 
3374 	NL80211_ATTR_PMK_LIFETIME,
3375 	NL80211_ATTR_PMK_REAUTH_THRESHOLD,
3376 
3377 	NL80211_ATTR_RECEIVE_MULTICAST,
3378 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET,
3379 	NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1_OFFSET,
3380 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ,
3381 
3382 	NL80211_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPABILITY,
3383 
3384 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_DISCOVERY,
3385 
3386 	NL80211_ATTR_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP,
3387 
3388 	NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY,
3389 	NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY_MASK,
3390 
3391 	NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PWE,
3392 
3393 	NL80211_ATTR_RECONNECT_REQUESTED,
3394 
3395 	NL80211_ATTR_SAR_SPEC,
3396 
3397 	NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HE,
3398 
3399 	NL80211_ATTR_OBSS_COLOR_BITMAP,
3400 
3401 	NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_COUNT,
3402 	NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_COLOR,
3403 	NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_ELEMS,
3404 
3405 	NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_CONFIG,
3406 	NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_ELEMS,
3407 
3408 	NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_BACKGROUND,
3409 
3410 	NL80211_ATTR_AP_SETTINGS_FLAGS,
3411 
3412 	NL80211_ATTR_EHT_CAPABILITY,
3413 
3414 	NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_EHT,
3415 
3416 	NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINKS,
3417 	NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID,
3418 	NL80211_ATTR_MLD_ADDR,
3419 
3420 	NL80211_ATTR_MLO_SUPPORT,
3421 
3422 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES,
3423 
3424 	NL80211_ATTR_EML_CAPABILITY,
3425 	NL80211_ATTR_MLD_CAPA_AND_OPS,
3426 
3427 	NL80211_ATTR_TX_HW_TIMESTAMP,
3428 	NL80211_ATTR_RX_HW_TIMESTAMP,
3429 	NL80211_ATTR_TD_BITMAP,
3430 
3431 	NL80211_ATTR_PUNCT_BITMAP,
3432 
3433 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_HW_TIMESTAMP_PEERS,
3434 	NL80211_ATTR_HW_TIMESTAMP_ENABLED,
3435 
3436 	NL80211_ATTR_EMA_RNR_ELEMS,
3437 
3438 	NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_DISABLED,
3439 
3440 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_DUMP_INCLUDE_USE_DATA,
3441 
3442 	NL80211_ATTR_MLO_TTLM_DLINK,
3443 	NL80211_ATTR_MLO_TTLM_ULINK,
3444 
3445 	NL80211_ATTR_ASSOC_SPP_AMSDU,
3446 
3447 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RADIOS,
3448 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS,
3449 
3450 	NL80211_ATTR_VIF_RADIO_MASK,
3451 
3452 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_SELECTORS,
3453 
3454 	NL80211_ATTR_MLO_RECONF_REM_LINKS,
3455 	NL80211_ATTR_EPCS,
3456 
3457 	NL80211_ATTR_ASSOC_MLD_EXT_CAPA_OPS,
3458 
3459 	/* add attributes here, update the policy in nl80211.c */
3460 
3461 	__NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
3462 	NUM_NL80211_ATTR = __NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
3463 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
3464 };
3465 
3466 /* source-level API compatibility */
3467 #define NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_GENERATION NL80211_ATTR_GENERATION
3468 #define	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_PARAMS NL80211_ATTR_MESH_CONFIG
3469 #define NL80211_ATTR_IFACE_SOCKET_OWNER NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER
3470 #define NL80211_ATTR_SAE_DATA NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_DATA
3471 #define NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFF_BEACON NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_BEACON
3472 #define NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFF_PRESP NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_PRESP
3473 
3474 /*
3475  * Allow user space programs to use #ifdef on new attributes by defining them
3476  * here
3477  */
3478 #define NL80211_CMD_CONNECT NL80211_CMD_CONNECT
3479 #define NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY
3480 #define NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES
3481 #define NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS
3482 #define NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ
3483 #define NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE
3484 #define NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE
3485 #define NL80211_ATTR_IE NL80211_ATTR_IE
3486 #define NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR
3487 #define NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE
3488 #define NL80211_ATTR_FRAME NL80211_ATTR_FRAME
3489 #define NL80211_ATTR_SSID NL80211_ATTR_SSID
3490 #define NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE
3491 #define NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE
3492 #define NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE
3493 #define NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP
3494 #define NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS
3495 #define NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES
3496 #define NL80211_ATTR_KEY NL80211_ATTR_KEY
3497 #define NL80211_ATTR_KEYS NL80211_ATTR_KEYS
3498 #define NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS
3499 
3500 #define NL80211_WIPHY_NAME_MAXLEN		64
3501 
3502 #define NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES			32
3503 #define NL80211_MAX_SUPP_SELECTORS		128
3504 #define NL80211_MAX_SUPP_HT_RATES		77
3505 #define NL80211_MAX_SUPP_REG_RULES		128
3506 #define NL80211_TKIP_DATA_OFFSET_ENCR_KEY	0
3507 #define NL80211_TKIP_DATA_OFFSET_TX_MIC_KEY	16
3508 #define NL80211_TKIP_DATA_OFFSET_RX_MIC_KEY	24
3509 #define NL80211_HT_CAPABILITY_LEN		26
3510 #define NL80211_VHT_CAPABILITY_LEN		12
3511 #define NL80211_HE_MIN_CAPABILITY_LEN           16
3512 #define NL80211_HE_MAX_CAPABILITY_LEN           54
3513 #define NL80211_MAX_NR_CIPHER_SUITES		5
3514 
3515 /*
3516  * NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES is obsolete when %NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES
3517  * present in %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY response.
3518  */
3519 #define NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES		2
3520 #define NL80211_EHT_MIN_CAPABILITY_LEN          13
3521 #define NL80211_EHT_MAX_CAPABILITY_LEN          51
3522 
3523 #define NL80211_MIN_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL_TIME	10
3524 
3525 /* default RSSI threshold for scan results if none specified. */
3526 #define NL80211_SCAN_RSSI_THOLD_OFF		-300
3527 
3528 #define NL80211_CQM_TXE_MAX_INTVL		1800
3529 
3530 /**
3531  * enum nl80211_iftype - (virtual) interface types
3532  *
3533  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_UNSPECIFIED: unspecified type, driver decides
3534  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_ADHOC: independent BSS member
3535  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION: managed BSS member
3536  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AP: access point
3537  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN: VLAN interface for access points; VLAN interfaces
3538  *	are a bit special in that they must always be tied to a pre-existing
3539  *	AP type interface.
3540  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_WDS: wireless distribution interface
3541  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_MONITOR: monitor interface receiving all frames
3542  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT: mesh point
3543  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT: P2P client
3544  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO: P2P group owner
3545  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_DEVICE: P2P device interface type, this is not a netdev
3546  *	and therefore can't be created in the normal ways, use the
3547  *	%NL80211_CMD_START_P2P_DEVICE and %NL80211_CMD_STOP_P2P_DEVICE
3548  *	commands to create and destroy one
3549  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_OCB: Outside Context of a BSS
3550  *	This mode corresponds to the MIB variable dot11OCBActivated=true
3551  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_NAN: NAN device interface type (not a netdev)
3552  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX: highest interface type number currently defined
3553  * @NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES: number of defined interface types
3554  *
3555  * These values are used with the %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE
3556  * to set the type of an interface.
3557  *
3558  */
3559 enum nl80211_iftype {
3560 	NL80211_IFTYPE_UNSPECIFIED,
3561 	NL80211_IFTYPE_ADHOC,
3562 	NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION,
3563 	NL80211_IFTYPE_AP,
3564 	NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN,
3565 	NL80211_IFTYPE_WDS,
3566 	NL80211_IFTYPE_MONITOR,
3567 	NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT,
3568 	NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT,
3569 	NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO,
3570 	NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_DEVICE,
3571 	NL80211_IFTYPE_OCB,
3572 	NL80211_IFTYPE_NAN,
3573 
3574 	/* keep last */
3575 	NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES,
3576 	NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX = NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES - 1
3577 };
3578 
3579 /**
3580  * enum nl80211_sta_flags - station flags
3581  *
3582  * Station flags. When a station is added to an AP interface, it is
3583  * assumed to be already associated (and hence authenticated.)
3584  *
3585  * @__NL80211_STA_FLAG_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3586  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X)
3587  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_SHORT_PREAMBLE: station is capable of receiving frames
3588  *	with short barker preamble
3589  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME: station is WME/QoS capable
3590  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_MFP: station uses management frame protection
3591  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHENTICATED: station is authenticated
3592  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_TDLS_PEER: station is a TDLS peer -- this flag should
3593  *	only be used in managed mode (even in the flags mask). Note that the
3594  *	flag can't be changed, it is only valid while adding a station, and
3595  *	attempts to change it will silently be ignored (rather than rejected
3596  *	as errors.)
3597  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_ASSOCIATED: station is associated; used with drivers
3598  *	that support %NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE to transition a
3599  *	previously added station into associated state
3600  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_SPP_AMSDU: station supports SPP A-MSDUs
3601  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_MAX: highest station flag number currently defined
3602  * @__NL80211_STA_FLAG_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3603  */
3604 enum nl80211_sta_flags {
3605 	__NL80211_STA_FLAG_INVALID,
3606 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED,
3607 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_SHORT_PREAMBLE,
3608 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME,
3609 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_MFP,
3610 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHENTICATED,
3611 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_TDLS_PEER,
3612 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_ASSOCIATED,
3613 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_SPP_AMSDU,
3614 
3615 	/* keep last */
3616 	__NL80211_STA_FLAG_AFTER_LAST,
3617 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_MAX = __NL80211_STA_FLAG_AFTER_LAST - 1
3618 };
3619 
3620 /**
3621  * enum nl80211_sta_p2p_ps_status - station support of P2P PS
3622  *
3623  * @NL80211_P2P_PS_UNSUPPORTED: station doesn't support P2P PS mechanism
3624  * @NL80211_P2P_PS_SUPPORTED: station supports P2P PS mechanism
3625  * @NUM_NL80211_P2P_PS_STATUS: number of values
3626  */
3627 enum nl80211_sta_p2p_ps_status {
3628 	NL80211_P2P_PS_UNSUPPORTED = 0,
3629 	NL80211_P2P_PS_SUPPORTED,
3630 
3631 	NUM_NL80211_P2P_PS_STATUS,
3632 };
3633 
3634 #define NL80211_STA_FLAG_MAX_OLD_API	NL80211_STA_FLAG_TDLS_PEER
3635 
3636 /**
3637  * struct nl80211_sta_flag_update - station flags mask/set
3638  * @mask: mask of station flags to set
3639  * @set: which values to set them to
3640  *
3641  * Both mask and set contain bits as per &enum nl80211_sta_flags.
3642  */
3643 struct nl80211_sta_flag_update {
3644 	__u32 mask;
3645 	__u32 set;
3646 } __attribute__((packed));
3647 
3648 /**
3649  * enum nl80211_he_gi - HE guard interval
3650  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_0_8: 0.8 usec
3651  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_1_6: 1.6 usec
3652  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_3_2: 3.2 usec
3653  */
3654 enum nl80211_he_gi {
3655 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_0_8,
3656 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_1_6,
3657 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_3_2,
3658 };
3659 
3660 /**
3661  * enum nl80211_he_ltf - HE long training field
3662  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_1XLTF: 3.2 usec
3663  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_2XLTF: 6.4 usec
3664  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_4XLTF: 12.8 usec
3665  */
3666 enum nl80211_he_ltf {
3667 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_1XLTF,
3668 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_2XLTF,
3669 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_4XLTF,
3670 };
3671 
3672 /**
3673  * enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc - HE RU allocation values
3674  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_26: 26-tone RU allocation
3675  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_52: 52-tone RU allocation
3676  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_106: 106-tone RU allocation
3677  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_242: 242-tone RU allocation
3678  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_484: 484-tone RU allocation
3679  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_996: 996-tone RU allocation
3680  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_2x996: 2x996-tone RU allocation
3681  */
3682 enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc {
3683 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_26,
3684 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_52,
3685 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_106,
3686 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_242,
3687 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_484,
3688 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_996,
3689 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_2x996,
3690 };
3691 
3692 /**
3693  * enum nl80211_eht_gi - EHT guard interval
3694  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_0_8: 0.8 usec
3695  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_1_6: 1.6 usec
3696  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_3_2: 3.2 usec
3697  */
3698 enum nl80211_eht_gi {
3699 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_0_8,
3700 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_1_6,
3701 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_3_2,
3702 };
3703 
3704 /**
3705  * enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc - EHT RU allocation values
3706  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_26: 26-tone RU allocation
3707  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_52: 52-tone RU allocation
3708  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_52P26: 52+26-tone RU allocation
3709  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_106: 106-tone RU allocation
3710  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_106P26: 106+26 tone RU allocation
3711  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_242: 242-tone RU allocation
3712  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_484: 484-tone RU allocation
3713  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_484P242: 484+242 tone RU allocation
3714  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996: 996-tone RU allocation
3715  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996P484: 996+484 tone RU allocation
3716  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996P484P242: 996+484+242 tone RU allocation
3717  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_2x996: 2x996-tone RU allocation
3718  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_2x996P484: 2x996+484 tone RU allocation
3719  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_3x996: 3x996-tone RU allocation
3720  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_3x996P484: 3x996+484 tone RU allocation
3721  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_4x996: 4x996-tone RU allocation
3722  */
3723 enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc {
3724 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_26,
3725 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_52,
3726 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_52P26,
3727 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_106,
3728 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_106P26,
3729 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_242,
3730 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_484,
3731 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_484P242,
3732 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996,
3733 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996P484,
3734 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996P484P242,
3735 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_2x996,
3736 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_2x996P484,
3737 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_3x996,
3738 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_3x996P484,
3739 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_4x996,
3740 };
3741 
3742 /**
3743  * enum nl80211_rate_info - bitrate information
3744  *
3745  * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_STA_INFO_TXRATE
3746  * when getting information about the bitrate of a station.
3747  * There are 2 attributes for bitrate, a legacy one that represents
3748  * a 16-bit value, and new one that represents a 32-bit value.
3749  * If the rate value fits into 16 bit, both attributes are reported
3750  * with the same value. If the rate is too high to fit into 16 bits
3751  * (>6.5535Gbps) only 32-bit attribute is included.
3752  * User space tools encouraged to use the 32-bit attribute and fall
3753  * back to the 16-bit one for compatibility with older kernels.
3754  *
3755  * @__NL80211_RATE_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3756  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE: total bitrate (u16, 100kbit/s)
3757  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_MCS: mcs index for 802.11n (u8)
3758  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_40_MHZ_WIDTH: 40 MHz dualchannel bitrate
3759  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_SHORT_GI: 400ns guard interval
3760  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE32: total bitrate (u32, 100kbit/s)
3761  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_MAX: highest rate_info number currently defined
3762  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_MCS: MCS index for VHT (u8)
3763  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_NSS: number of streams in VHT (u8)
3764  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_80_MHZ_WIDTH: 80 MHz VHT rate
3765  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_80P80_MHZ_WIDTH: unused - 80+80 is treated the
3766  *	same as 160 for purposes of the bitrates
3767  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_160_MHZ_WIDTH: 160 MHz VHT rate
3768  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_10_MHZ_WIDTH: 10 MHz width - note that this is
3769  *	a legacy rate and will be reported as the actual bitrate, i.e.
3770  *	half the base (20 MHz) rate
3771  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_5_MHZ_WIDTH: 5 MHz width - note that this is
3772  *	a legacy rate and will be reported as the actual bitrate, i.e.
3773  *	a quarter of the base (20 MHz) rate
3774  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_MCS: HE MCS index (u8, 0-11)
3775  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_NSS: HE NSS value (u8, 1-8)
3776  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI: HE guard interval identifier
3777  *	(u8, see &enum nl80211_he_gi)
3778  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_DCM: HE DCM value (u8, 0/1)
3779  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC: HE RU allocation, if not present then
3780  *	non-OFDMA was used (u8, see &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc)
3781  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_320_MHZ_WIDTH: 320 MHz bitrate
3782  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_MCS: EHT MCS index (u8, 0-15)
3783  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_NSS: EHT NSS value (u8, 1-8)
3784  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI: EHT guard interval identifier
3785  *	(u8, see &enum nl80211_eht_gi)
3786  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC: EHT RU allocation, if not present then
3787  *	non-OFDMA was used (u8, see &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc)
3788  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_S1G_MCS: S1G MCS index (u8, 0-10)
3789  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_S1G_NSS: S1G NSS value (u8, 1-4)
3790  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_1_MHZ_WIDTH: 1 MHz S1G rate
3791  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_2_MHZ_WIDTH: 2 MHz S1G rate
3792  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_4_MHZ_WIDTH: 4 MHz S1G rate
3793  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_8_MHZ_WIDTH: 8 MHz S1G rate
3794  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_16_MHZ_WIDTH: 16 MHz S1G rate
3795  * @__NL80211_RATE_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3796  */
3797 enum nl80211_rate_info {
3798 	__NL80211_RATE_INFO_INVALID,
3799 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE,
3800 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_MCS,
3801 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_40_MHZ_WIDTH,
3802 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_SHORT_GI,
3803 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE32,
3804 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_MCS,
3805 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_NSS,
3806 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_80_MHZ_WIDTH,
3807 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_80P80_MHZ_WIDTH,
3808 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_160_MHZ_WIDTH,
3809 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_10_MHZ_WIDTH,
3810 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_5_MHZ_WIDTH,
3811 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_MCS,
3812 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_NSS,
3813 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI,
3814 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_DCM,
3815 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC,
3816 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_320_MHZ_WIDTH,
3817 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_MCS,
3818 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_NSS,
3819 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI,
3820 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC,
3821 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_S1G_MCS,
3822 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_S1G_NSS,
3823 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_1_MHZ_WIDTH,
3824 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_2_MHZ_WIDTH,
3825 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_4_MHZ_WIDTH,
3826 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_8_MHZ_WIDTH,
3827 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_16_MHZ_WIDTH,
3828 
3829 	/* keep last */
3830 	__NL80211_RATE_INFO_AFTER_LAST,
3831 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_RATE_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1
3832 };
3833 
3834 /**
3835  * enum nl80211_sta_bss_param - BSS information collected by STA
3836  *
3837  * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_STA_INFO_BSS_PARAM
3838  * when getting information about the bitrate of a station.
3839  *
3840  * @__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3841  * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled (flag)
3842  * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_PREAMBLE:  whether short preamble is enabled
3843  *	(flag)
3844  * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_SLOT_TIME:  whether short slot time is enabled
3845  *	(flag)
3846  * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_DTIM_PERIOD: DTIM period for beaconing (u8)
3847  * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_BEACON_INTERVAL: Beacon interval (u16)
3848  * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_MAX: highest sta_bss_param number currently defined
3849  * @__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3850  */
3851 enum nl80211_sta_bss_param {
3852 	__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_INVALID,
3853 	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_CTS_PROT,
3854 	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_PREAMBLE,
3855 	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_SLOT_TIME,
3856 	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_DTIM_PERIOD,
3857 	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_BEACON_INTERVAL,
3858 
3859 	/* keep last */
3860 	__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_AFTER_LAST,
3861 	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_MAX = __NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_AFTER_LAST - 1
3862 };
3863 
3864 /**
3865  * enum nl80211_sta_info - station information
3866  *
3867  * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_STA_INFO
3868  * when getting information about a station.
3869  *
3870  * @__NL80211_STA_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3871  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_INACTIVE_TIME: time since last activity (u32, msecs)
3872  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES: total received bytes (MPDU length)
3873  *	(u32, from this station)
3874  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES: total transmitted bytes (MPDU length)
3875  *	(u32, to this station)
3876  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES64: total received bytes (MPDU length)
3877  *	(u64, from this station)
3878  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES64: total transmitted bytes (MPDU length)
3879  *	(u64, to this station)
3880  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL: signal strength of last received PPDU (u8, dBm)
3881  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BITRATE: current unicast tx rate, nested attribute
3882  *	containing info as possible, see &enum nl80211_rate_info
3883  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_PACKETS: total received packet (MSDUs and MMPDUs)
3884  *	(u32, from this station)
3885  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_PACKETS: total transmitted packets (MSDUs and MMPDUs)
3886  *	(u32, to this station)
3887  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_RETRIES: total retries (MPDUs) (u32, to this station)
3888  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_FAILED: total failed packets (MPDUs)
3889  *	(u32, to this station)
3890  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL_AVG: signal strength average (u8, dBm)
3891  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_LLID: the station's mesh LLID
3892  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PLID: the station's mesh PLID
3893  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PLINK_STATE: peer link state for the station
3894  *	(see %enum nl80211_plink_state)
3895  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BITRATE: last unicast data frame rx rate, nested
3896  *	attribute, like NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BITRATE.
3897  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BSS_PARAM: current station's view of BSS, nested attribute
3898  *     containing info as possible, see &enum nl80211_sta_bss_param
3899  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TIME: time since the station is last connected
3900  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_STA_FLAGS: Contains a struct nl80211_sta_flag_update.
3901  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_LOSS: count of times beacon loss was detected (u32)
3902  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_T_OFFSET: timing offset with respect to this STA (s64)
3903  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_LOCAL_PM: local mesh STA link-specific power mode
3904  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PEER_PM: peer mesh STA link-specific power mode
3905  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_NONPEER_PM: neighbor mesh STA power save mode towards
3906  *	non-peer STA
3907  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL: per-chain signal strength of last PPDU
3908  *	Contains a nested array of signal strength attributes (u8, dBm)
3909  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL_AVG: per-chain signal strength average
3910  *	Same format as NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL.
3911  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_EXPECTED_THROUGHPUT: expected throughput considering also
3912  *	the 802.11 header (u32, kbps)
3913  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DROP_MISC: RX packets dropped for unspecified reasons
3914  *	(u64)
3915  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_RX: number of beacons received from this peer (u64)
3916  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_SIGNAL_AVG: signal strength average
3917  *	for beacons only (u8, dBm)
3918  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TID_STATS: per-TID statistics (see &enum nl80211_tid_stats)
3919  *	This is a nested attribute where each the inner attribute number is the
3920  *	TID+1 and the special TID 16 (i.e. value 17) is used for non-QoS frames;
3921  *	each one of those is again nested with &enum nl80211_tid_stats
3922  *	attributes carrying the actual values.
3923  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DURATION: aggregate PPDU duration for all frames
3924  *	received from the station (u64, usec)
3925  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
3926  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL: signal strength of the last ACK frame(u8, dBm)
3927  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG: avg signal strength of ACK frames (s8, dBm)
3928  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_MPDUS: total number of received packets (MPDUs)
3929  *	(u32, from this station)
3930  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_FCS_ERROR_COUNT: total number of packets (MPDUs) received
3931  *	with an FCS error (u32, from this station). This count may not include
3932  *	some packets with an FCS error due to TA corruption. Hence this counter
3933  *	might not be fully accurate.
3934  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_GATE: set to true if STA has a path to a
3935  *	mesh gate (u8, 0 or 1)
3936  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_DURATION: aggregate PPDU duration for all frames
3937  *	sent to the station (u64, usec)
3938  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_WEIGHT: current airtime weight for station (u16)
3939  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_LINK_METRIC: airtime link metric for mesh station
3940  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_ASSOC_AT_BOOTTIME: Timestamp (CLOCK_BOOTTIME, nanoseconds)
3941  *	of STA's association
3942  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_AS: set to true if STA has a path to a
3943  *	authentication server (u8, 0 or 1)
3944  * @__NL80211_STA_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal
3945  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_MAX: highest possible station info attribute
3946  */
3947 enum nl80211_sta_info {
3948 	__NL80211_STA_INFO_INVALID,
3949 	NL80211_STA_INFO_INACTIVE_TIME,
3950 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES,
3951 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES,
3952 	NL80211_STA_INFO_LLID,
3953 	NL80211_STA_INFO_PLID,
3954 	NL80211_STA_INFO_PLINK_STATE,
3955 	NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL,
3956 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BITRATE,
3957 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_PACKETS,
3958 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_PACKETS,
3959 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_RETRIES,
3960 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_FAILED,
3961 	NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL_AVG,
3962 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BITRATE,
3963 	NL80211_STA_INFO_BSS_PARAM,
3964 	NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TIME,
3965 	NL80211_STA_INFO_STA_FLAGS,
3966 	NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_LOSS,
3967 	NL80211_STA_INFO_T_OFFSET,
3968 	NL80211_STA_INFO_LOCAL_PM,
3969 	NL80211_STA_INFO_PEER_PM,
3970 	NL80211_STA_INFO_NONPEER_PM,
3971 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES64,
3972 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES64,
3973 	NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL,
3974 	NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL_AVG,
3975 	NL80211_STA_INFO_EXPECTED_THROUGHPUT,
3976 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DROP_MISC,
3977 	NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_RX,
3978 	NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_SIGNAL_AVG,
3979 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TID_STATS,
3980 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DURATION,
3981 	NL80211_STA_INFO_PAD,
3982 	NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL,
3983 	NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG,
3984 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_MPDUS,
3985 	NL80211_STA_INFO_FCS_ERROR_COUNT,
3986 	NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_GATE,
3987 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_DURATION,
3988 	NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_WEIGHT,
3989 	NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_LINK_METRIC,
3990 	NL80211_STA_INFO_ASSOC_AT_BOOTTIME,
3991 	NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_AS,
3992 
3993 	/* keep last */
3994 	__NL80211_STA_INFO_AFTER_LAST,
3995 	NL80211_STA_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_STA_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1
3996 };
3997 
3998 /* we renamed this - stay compatible */
3999 #define NL80211_STA_INFO_DATA_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG
4000 
4001 
4002 /**
4003  * enum nl80211_tid_stats - per TID statistics attributes
4004  * @__NL80211_TID_STATS_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4005  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_RX_MSDU: number of MSDUs received (u64)
4006  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU: number of MSDUs transmitted (or
4007  *	attempted to transmit; u64)
4008  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_RETRIES: number of retries for
4009  *	transmitted MSDUs (not counting the first attempt; u64)
4010  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_FAILED: number of failed transmitted
4011  *	MSDUs (u64)
4012  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
4013  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TXQ_STATS: TXQ stats (nested attribute)
4014  * @NUM_NL80211_TID_STATS: number of attributes here
4015  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_MAX: highest numbered attribute here
4016  */
4017 enum nl80211_tid_stats {
4018 	__NL80211_TID_STATS_INVALID,
4019 	NL80211_TID_STATS_RX_MSDU,
4020 	NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU,
4021 	NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_RETRIES,
4022 	NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_FAILED,
4023 	NL80211_TID_STATS_PAD,
4024 	NL80211_TID_STATS_TXQ_STATS,
4025 
4026 	/* keep last */
4027 	NUM_NL80211_TID_STATS,
4028 	NL80211_TID_STATS_MAX = NUM_NL80211_TID_STATS - 1
4029 };
4030 
4031 /**
4032  * enum nl80211_txq_stats - per TXQ statistics attributes
4033  * @__NL80211_TXQ_STATS_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4034  * @NUM_NL80211_TXQ_STATS: number of attributes here
4035  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_BYTES: number of bytes currently backlogged
4036  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_PACKETS: number of packets currently
4037  *      backlogged
4038  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_FLOWS: total number of new flows seen
4039  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_DROPS: total number of packet drops
4040  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_ECN_MARKS: total number of packet ECN marks
4041  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERLIMIT: number of drops due to queue space overflow
4042  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERMEMORY: number of drops due to memory limit overflow
4043  *      (only for per-phy stats)
4044  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_COLLISIONS: number of hash collisions
4045  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_BYTES: total number of bytes dequeued from TXQ
4046  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_PACKETS: total number of packets dequeued from TXQ
4047  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX_FLOWS: number of flow buckets for PHY
4048  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX: highest numbered attribute here
4049  */
4050 enum nl80211_txq_stats {
4051 	__NL80211_TXQ_STATS_INVALID,
4052 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_BYTES,
4053 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_PACKETS,
4054 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_FLOWS,
4055 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_DROPS,
4056 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_ECN_MARKS,
4057 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERLIMIT,
4058 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERMEMORY,
4059 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_COLLISIONS,
4060 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_BYTES,
4061 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_PACKETS,
4062 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX_FLOWS,
4063 
4064 	/* keep last */
4065 	NUM_NL80211_TXQ_STATS,
4066 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX = NUM_NL80211_TXQ_STATS - 1
4067 };
4068 
4069 /**
4070  * enum nl80211_mpath_flags - nl80211 mesh path flags
4071  *
4072  * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_ACTIVE: the mesh path is active
4073  * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVING: the mesh path discovery process is running
4074  * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_SN_VALID: the mesh path contains a valid SN
4075  * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_FIXED: the mesh path has been manually set
4076  * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVED: the mesh path discovery process succeeded
4077  */
4078 enum nl80211_mpath_flags {
4079 	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_ACTIVE =	1<<0,
4080 	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVING =	1<<1,
4081 	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_SN_VALID =	1<<2,
4082 	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_FIXED =	1<<3,
4083 	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVED =	1<<4,
4084 };
4085 
4086 /**
4087  * enum nl80211_mpath_info - mesh path information
4088  *
4089  * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_INFO when getting
4090  * information about a mesh path.
4091  *
4092  * @__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4093  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN: number of queued frames for this destination
4094  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_SN: destination sequence number
4095  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_METRIC: metric (cost) of this mesh path
4096  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME: expiration time for the path, in msec from now
4097  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FLAGS: mesh path flags, enumerated in
4098  *	&enum nl80211_mpath_flags;
4099  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: total path discovery timeout, in msec
4100  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES: mesh path discovery retries
4101  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT: hop count to destination
4102  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE: total number of path changes to destination
4103  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_MAX: highest mesh path information attribute number
4104  *	currently defined
4105  * @__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4106  */
4107 enum nl80211_mpath_info {
4108 	__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_INVALID,
4109 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN,
4110 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_SN,
4111 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_METRIC,
4112 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME,
4113 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FLAGS,
4114 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT,
4115 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES,
4116 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT,
4117 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE,
4118 
4119 	/* keep last */
4120 	__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_AFTER_LAST,
4121 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_MPATH_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1
4122 };
4123 
4124 /**
4125  * enum nl80211_band_iftype_attr - Interface type data attributes
4126  *
4127  * @__NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4128  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_IFTYPES: nested attribute containing a flag attribute
4129  *     for each interface type that supports the band data
4130  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MAC: HE MAC capabilities as in HE
4131  *     capabilities IE
4132  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PHY: HE PHY capabilities as in HE
4133  *     capabilities IE
4134  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MCS_SET: HE supported NSS/MCS as in HE
4135  *     capabilities IE
4136  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PPE: HE PPE thresholds information as
4137  *     defined in HE capabilities IE
4138  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPA: HE 6GHz band capabilities (__le16),
4139  *	given for all 6 GHz band channels
4140  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_VENDOR_ELEMS: vendor element capabilities that are
4141  *	advertised on this band/for this iftype (binary)
4142  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_MAC: EHT MAC capabilities as in EHT
4143  *	capabilities element
4144  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_PHY: EHT PHY capabilities as in EHT
4145  *	capabilities element
4146  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_MCS_SET: EHT supported NSS/MCS as in EHT
4147  *	capabilities element
4148  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_PPE: EHT PPE thresholds information as
4149  *	defined in EHT capabilities element
4150  * @__NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4151  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_MAX: highest band attribute currently defined
4152  */
4153 enum nl80211_band_iftype_attr {
4154 	__NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_INVALID,
4155 
4156 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_IFTYPES,
4157 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MAC,
4158 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PHY,
4159 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MCS_SET,
4160 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PPE,
4161 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPA,
4162 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_VENDOR_ELEMS,
4163 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_MAC,
4164 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_PHY,
4165 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_MCS_SET,
4166 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_PPE,
4167 
4168 	/* keep last */
4169 	__NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4170 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4171 };
4172 
4173 /**
4174  * enum nl80211_band_attr - band attributes
4175  * @__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4176  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_FREQS: supported frequencies in this band,
4177  *	an array of nested frequency attributes
4178  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_RATES: supported bitrates in this band,
4179  *	an array of nested bitrate attributes
4180  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_MCS_SET: 16-byte attribute containing the MCS set as
4181  *	defined in 802.11n
4182  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA: HT capabilities, as in the HT information IE
4183  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_FACTOR: A-MPDU factor, as in 11n
4184  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_DENSITY: A-MPDU density, as in 11n
4185  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_MCS_SET: 32-byte attribute containing the MCS set as
4186  *	defined in 802.11ac
4187  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_CAPA: VHT capabilities, as in the HT information IE
4188  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_IFTYPE_DATA: nested array attribute, with each entry using
4189  *	attributes from &enum nl80211_band_iftype_attr
4190  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_CHANNELS: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz
4191  *	channel(s) that are allowed to be used for EDMG transmissions.
4192  *	Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251.
4193  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_BW_CONFIG: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes
4194  *	the allowed channel bandwidth configurations.
4195  *	Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251, Table 13.
4196  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_S1G_MCS_NSS_SET: S1G capabilities, supported S1G-MCS and NSS
4197  *	set subfield, as in the S1G information IE, 5 bytes
4198  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_S1G_CAPA: S1G capabilities information subfield as in the
4199  *	S1G information IE, 10 bytes
4200  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_MAX: highest band attribute currently defined
4201  * @__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4202  */
4203 enum nl80211_band_attr {
4204 	__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_INVALID,
4205 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_FREQS,
4206 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_RATES,
4207 
4208 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_MCS_SET,
4209 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA,
4210 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_FACTOR,
4211 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_DENSITY,
4212 
4213 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_MCS_SET,
4214 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_CAPA,
4215 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_IFTYPE_DATA,
4216 
4217 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_CHANNELS,
4218 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_BW_CONFIG,
4219 
4220 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_S1G_MCS_NSS_SET,
4221 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_S1G_CAPA,
4222 
4223 	/* keep last */
4224 	__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4225 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BAND_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4226 };
4227 
4228 #define NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA
4229 
4230 /**
4231  * enum nl80211_wmm_rule - regulatory wmm rule
4232  *
4233  * @__NL80211_WMMR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4234  * @NL80211_WMMR_CW_MIN: Minimum contention window slot.
4235  * @NL80211_WMMR_CW_MAX: Maximum contention window slot.
4236  * @NL80211_WMMR_AIFSN: Arbitration Inter Frame Space.
4237  * @NL80211_WMMR_TXOP: Maximum allowed tx operation time.
4238  * @NL80211_WMMR_MAX: highest possible wmm rule.
4239  * @__NL80211_WMMR_LAST: Internal use.
4240  */
4241 enum nl80211_wmm_rule {
4242 	__NL80211_WMMR_INVALID,
4243 	NL80211_WMMR_CW_MIN,
4244 	NL80211_WMMR_CW_MAX,
4245 	NL80211_WMMR_AIFSN,
4246 	NL80211_WMMR_TXOP,
4247 
4248 	/* keep last */
4249 	__NL80211_WMMR_LAST,
4250 	NL80211_WMMR_MAX = __NL80211_WMMR_LAST - 1
4251 };
4252 
4253 /**
4254  * enum nl80211_frequency_attr - frequency attributes
4255  * @__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4256  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_FREQ: Frequency in MHz
4257  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DISABLED: Channel is disabled in current
4258  *	regulatory domain.
4259  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR: no mechanisms that initiate radiation
4260  *	are permitted on this channel, this includes sending probe
4261  *	requests, or modes of operation that require beaconing.
4262  * @__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IBSS: obsolete, same as _NO_IR
4263  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_RADAR: Radar detection is mandatory
4264  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4265  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER: Maximum transmission power in mBm
4266  *	(100 * dBm).
4267  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_STATE: current state for DFS
4268  *	(enum nl80211_dfs_state)
4269  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_TIME: time in milliseconds for how long
4270  *	this channel is in this DFS state.
4271  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_MINUS: HT40- isn't possible with this
4272  *	channel as the control channel
4273  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_PLUS: HT40+ isn't possible with this
4274  *	channel as the control channel
4275  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_80MHZ: any 80 MHz channel using this channel
4276  *	as the primary or any of the secondary channels isn't possible,
4277  *	this includes 80+80 channels
4278  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_160MHZ: any 160 MHz (but not 80+80) channel
4279  *	using this channel as the primary or any of the secondary channels
4280  *	isn't possible
4281  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME: DFS CAC time in milliseconds.
4282  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY: Only indoor use is permitted on this
4283  *	channel. A channel that has the INDOOR_ONLY attribute can only be
4284  *	used when there is a clear assessment that the device is operating in
4285  *	an indoor surroundings, i.e., it is connected to AC power (and not
4286  *	through portable DC inverters) or is under the control of a master
4287  *	that is acting as an AP and is connected to AC power.
4288  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT: IR operation is allowed on this
4289  *	channel if it's connected concurrently to a BSS on the same channel on
4290  *	the 2 GHz band or to a channel in the same UNII band (on the 5 GHz
4291  *	band), and IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR is not set. Instantiating a GO or TDLS
4292  *	off-channel on a channel that has the IR_CONCURRENT attribute set can be
4293  *	done when there is a clear assessment that the device is operating under
4294  *	the guidance of an authorized master, i.e., setting up a GO or TDLS
4295  *	off-channel while the device is also connected to an AP with DFS and
4296  *	radar detection on the UNII band (it is up to user-space, i.e.,
4297  *	wpa_supplicant to perform the required verifications). Using this
4298  *	attribute for IR is disallowed for master interfaces (IBSS, AP).
4299  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_20MHZ: 20 MHz operation is not allowed
4300  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4301  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_10MHZ: 10 MHz operation is not allowed
4302  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4303  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_WMM: this channel has wmm limitations.
4304  *	This is a nested attribute that contains the wmm limitation per AC.
4305  *	(see &enum nl80211_wmm_rule)
4306  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HE: HE operation is not allowed on this channel
4307  *	in current regulatory domain.
4308  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_OFFSET: frequency offset in KHz
4309  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_1MHZ: 1 MHz operation is allowed
4310  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4311  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_2MHZ: 2 MHz operation is allowed
4312  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4313  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_4MHZ: 4 MHz operation is allowed
4314  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4315  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_8MHZ: 8 MHz operation is allowed
4316  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4317  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_16MHZ: 16 MHz operation is allowed
4318  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4319  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_320MHZ: any 320 MHz channel using this channel
4320  *	as the primary or any of the secondary channels isn't possible
4321  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_EHT: EHT operation is not allowed on this channel
4322  *	in current regulatory domain.
4323  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_PSD: Power spectral density (in dBm) that
4324  *	is allowed on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4325  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_CONCURRENT: Operation on this channel is
4326  *	allowed for peer-to-peer or adhoc communication under the control
4327  *	of a DFS master which operates on the same channel (FCC-594280 D01
4328  *	Section B.3). Should be used together with %NL80211_RRF_DFS only.
4329  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_6GHZ_VLP_CLIENT: Client connection to VLP AP
4330  *	not allowed using this channel
4331  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_6GHZ_AFC_CLIENT: Client connection to AFC AP
4332  *	not allowed using this channel
4333  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_CAN_MONITOR: This channel can be used in monitor
4334  *	mode despite other (regulatory) restrictions, even if the channel is
4335  *	otherwise completely disabled.
4336  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_ALLOW_6GHZ_VLP_AP: This channel can be used for a
4337  *	very low power (VLP) AP, despite being NO_IR.
4338  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_ALLOW_20MHZ_ACTIVITY: This channel can be active in
4339  *	20 MHz bandwidth, despite being NO_IR.
4340  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX: highest frequency attribute number
4341  *	currently defined
4342  * @__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4343  *
4344  * See https://apps.fcc.gov/eas/comments/GetPublishedDocument.html?id=327&tn=528122
4345  * for more information on the FCC description of the relaxations allowed
4346  * by NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY and
4347  * NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT.
4348  */
4349 enum nl80211_frequency_attr {
4350 	__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INVALID,
4351 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_FREQ,
4352 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DISABLED,
4353 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR,
4354 	__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IBSS,
4355 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_RADAR,
4356 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER,
4357 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_STATE,
4358 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_TIME,
4359 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_MINUS,
4360 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_PLUS,
4361 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_80MHZ,
4362 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_160MHZ,
4363 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME,
4364 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY,
4365 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT,
4366 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_20MHZ,
4367 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_10MHZ,
4368 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_WMM,
4369 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HE,
4370 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_OFFSET,
4371 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_1MHZ,
4372 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_2MHZ,
4373 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_4MHZ,
4374 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_8MHZ,
4375 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_16MHZ,
4376 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_320MHZ,
4377 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_EHT,
4378 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_PSD,
4379 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_CONCURRENT,
4380 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_6GHZ_VLP_CLIENT,
4381 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_6GHZ_AFC_CLIENT,
4382 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_CAN_MONITOR,
4383 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_ALLOW_6GHZ_VLP_AP,
4384 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_ALLOW_20MHZ_ACTIVITY,
4385 
4386 	/* keep last */
4387 	__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4388 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4389 };
4390 
4391 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER
4392 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_PASSIVE_SCAN	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR
4393 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IBSS		NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR
4394 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR		NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR
4395 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_GO_CONCURRENT \
4396 					NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT
4397 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_UHB_VLP_CLIENT \
4398 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_6GHZ_VLP_CLIENT
4399 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_UHB_AFC_CLIENT \
4400 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_6GHZ_AFC_CLIENT
4401 
4402 /**
4403  * enum nl80211_bitrate_attr - bitrate attributes
4404  * @__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4405  * @NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_RATE: Bitrate in units of 100 kbps
4406  * @NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_2GHZ_SHORTPREAMBLE: Short preamble supported
4407  *	in 2.4 GHz band.
4408  * @NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_MAX: highest bitrate attribute number
4409  *	currently defined
4410  * @__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4411  */
4412 enum nl80211_bitrate_attr {
4413 	__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_INVALID,
4414 	NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_RATE,
4415 	NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_2GHZ_SHORTPREAMBLE,
4416 
4417 	/* keep last */
4418 	__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4419 	NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4420 };
4421 
4422 /**
4423  * enum nl80211_reg_initiator - Indicates the initiator of a reg domain request
4424  * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_CORE: Core queried CRDA for a dynamic world
4425  *	regulatory domain.
4426  * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_USER: User asked the wireless core to set the
4427  *	regulatory domain.
4428  * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER: a wireless drivers has hinted to the
4429  *	wireless core it thinks its knows the regulatory domain we should be in.
4430  * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_COUNTRY_IE: the wireless core has received an
4431  *	802.11 country information element with regulatory information it
4432  *	thinks we should consider. cfg80211 only processes the country
4433  *	code from the IE, and relies on the regulatory domain information
4434  *	structure passed by userspace (CRDA) from our wireless-regdb.
4435  *	If a channel is enabled but the country code indicates it should
4436  *	be disabled we disable the channel and re-enable it upon disassociation.
4437  */
4438 enum nl80211_reg_initiator {
4439 	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_CORE,
4440 	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_USER,
4441 	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER,
4442 	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_COUNTRY_IE,
4443 };
4444 
4445 /**
4446  * enum nl80211_reg_type - specifies the type of regulatory domain
4447  * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_COUNTRY: the regulatory domain set is one that pertains
4448  *	to a specific country. When this is set you can count on the
4449  *	ISO / IEC 3166 alpha2 country code being valid.
4450  * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_WORLD: the regulatory set domain is the world regulatory
4451  *	domain.
4452  * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_CUSTOM_WORLD: the regulatory domain set is a custom
4453  *	driver specific world regulatory domain. These do not apply system-wide
4454  *	and are only applicable to the individual devices which have requested
4455  *	them to be applied.
4456  * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_INTERSECTION: the regulatory domain set is the product
4457  *	of an intersection between two regulatory domains -- the previously
4458  *	set regulatory domain on the system and the last accepted regulatory
4459  *	domain request to be processed.
4460  */
4461 enum nl80211_reg_type {
4462 	NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_COUNTRY,
4463 	NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_WORLD,
4464 	NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_CUSTOM_WORLD,
4465 	NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_INTERSECTION,
4466 };
4467 
4468 /**
4469  * enum nl80211_reg_rule_attr - regulatory rule attributes
4470  * @__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4471  * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FLAGS: a set of flags which specify additional
4472  *	considerations for a given frequency range. These are the
4473  *	&enum nl80211_reg_rule_flags.
4474  * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_START: starting frequencry for the regulatory
4475  *	rule in KHz. This is not a center of frequency but an actual regulatory
4476  *	band edge.
4477  * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_END: ending frequency for the regulatory rule
4478  *	in KHz. This is not a center a frequency but an actual regulatory
4479  *	band edge.
4480  * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_MAX_BW: maximum allowed bandwidth for this
4481  *	frequency range, in KHz.
4482  * @NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_ANT_GAIN: the maximum allowed antenna gain
4483  *	for a given frequency range. The value is in mBi (100 * dBi).
4484  *	If you don't have one then don't send this.
4485  * @NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_EIRP: the maximum allowed EIRP for
4486  *	a given frequency range. The value is in mBm (100 * dBm).
4487  * @NL80211_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME: DFS CAC time in milliseconds.
4488  *	If not present or 0 default CAC time will be used.
4489  * @NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_PSD: power spectral density (in dBm).
4490  *	This could be negative.
4491  * @NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_MAX: highest regulatory rule attribute number
4492  *	currently defined
4493  * @__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4494  */
4495 enum nl80211_reg_rule_attr {
4496 	__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_INVALID,
4497 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FLAGS,
4498 
4499 	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_START,
4500 	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_END,
4501 	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_MAX_BW,
4502 
4503 	NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_ANT_GAIN,
4504 	NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_EIRP,
4505 
4506 	NL80211_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME,
4507 
4508 	NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_PSD,
4509 
4510 	/* keep last */
4511 	__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4512 	NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4513 };
4514 
4515 /**
4516  * enum nl80211_sched_scan_match_attr - scheduled scan match attributes
4517  * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4518  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_SSID: SSID to be used for matching,
4519  *	only report BSS with matching SSID.
4520  *	(This cannot be used together with BSSID.)
4521  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI: RSSI threshold (in dBm) for reporting a
4522  *	BSS in scan results. Filtering is turned off if not specified. Note that
4523  *	if this attribute is in a match set of its own, then it is treated as
4524  *	the default value for all matchsets with an SSID, rather than being a
4525  *	matchset of its own without an RSSI filter. This is due to problems with
4526  *	how this API was implemented in the past. Also, due to the same problem,
4527  *	the only way to create a matchset with only an RSSI filter (with this
4528  *	attribute) is if there's only a single matchset with the RSSI attribute.
4529  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RELATIVE_RSSI: Flag indicating whether
4530  *	%NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI to be used as absolute RSSI or
4531  *	relative to current bss's RSSI.
4532  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST: When present the RSSI level for
4533  *	BSS-es in the specified band is to be adjusted before doing
4534  *	RSSI-based BSS selection. The attribute value is a packed structure
4535  *	value as specified by &struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust.
4536  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_BSSID: BSSID to be used for matching
4537  *	(this cannot be used together with SSID).
4538  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_PER_BAND_RSSI: Obsolete
4539  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX: highest scheduled scan filter
4540  *	attribute number currently defined
4541  * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4542  */
4543 enum nl80211_sched_scan_match_attr {
4544 	__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_INVALID,
4545 
4546 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_SSID,
4547 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI,
4548 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RELATIVE_RSSI,
4549 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST,
4550 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_BSSID,
4551 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_PER_BAND_RSSI, /* obsolete */
4552 
4553 	/* keep last */
4554 	__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4555 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX =
4556 		__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4557 };
4558 
4559 /* only for backward compatibility */
4560 #define NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_SSID NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_SSID
4561 
4562 /**
4563  * enum nl80211_reg_rule_flags - regulatory rule flags
4564  *
4565  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_OFDM: OFDM modulation not allowed
4566  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_CCK: CCK modulation not allowed
4567  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_INDOOR: indoor operation not allowed
4568  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_OUTDOOR: outdoor operation not allowed
4569  * @NL80211_RRF_DFS: DFS support is required to be used
4570  * @NL80211_RRF_PTP_ONLY: this is only for Point To Point links
4571  * @NL80211_RRF_PTMP_ONLY: this is only for Point To Multi Point links
4572  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_IR: no mechanisms that initiate radiation are allowed,
4573  *	this includes probe requests or modes of operation that require
4574  *	beaconing.
4575  * @__NL80211_RRF_NO_IBSS: obsolete, same as NO_IR
4576  * @NL80211_RRF_AUTO_BW: maximum available bandwidth should be calculated
4577  *	base on contiguous rules and wider channels will be allowed to cross
4578  *	multiple contiguous/overlapping frequency ranges.
4579  * @NL80211_RRF_IR_CONCURRENT: See %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT
4580  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40MINUS: channels can't be used in HT40- operation
4581  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40PLUS: channels can't be used in HT40+ operation
4582  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_80MHZ: 80MHz operation not allowed
4583  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_160MHZ: 160MHz operation not allowed
4584  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_HE: HE operation not allowed
4585  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_320MHZ: 320MHz operation not allowed
4586  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_EHT: EHT operation not allowed
4587  * @NL80211_RRF_PSD: Ruleset has power spectral density value
4588  * @NL80211_RRF_DFS_CONCURRENT: Operation on this channel is allowed for
4589  *	peer-to-peer or adhoc communication under the control of a DFS master
4590  *	which operates on the same channel (FCC-594280 D01 Section B.3).
4591  *	Should be used together with %NL80211_RRF_DFS only.
4592  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_6GHZ_VLP_CLIENT: Client connection to VLP AP not allowed
4593  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_6GHZ_AFC_CLIENT: Client connection to AFC AP not allowed
4594  * @NL80211_RRF_ALLOW_6GHZ_VLP_AP: Very low power (VLP) AP can be permitted
4595  *	despite NO_IR configuration.
4596  * @NL80211_RRF_ALLOW_20MHZ_ACTIVITY: Allow activity in 20 MHz bandwidth,
4597  *	despite NO_IR configuration.
4598  */
4599 enum nl80211_reg_rule_flags {
4600 	NL80211_RRF_NO_OFDM                 = 1 << 0,
4601 	NL80211_RRF_NO_CCK                  = 1 << 1,
4602 	NL80211_RRF_NO_INDOOR               = 1 << 2,
4603 	NL80211_RRF_NO_OUTDOOR              = 1 << 3,
4604 	NL80211_RRF_DFS                     = 1 << 4,
4605 	NL80211_RRF_PTP_ONLY                = 1 << 5,
4606 	NL80211_RRF_PTMP_ONLY               = 1 << 6,
4607 	NL80211_RRF_NO_IR                   = 1 << 7,
4608 	__NL80211_RRF_NO_IBSS               = 1 << 8,
4609 	NL80211_RRF_AUTO_BW                 = 1 << 11,
4610 	NL80211_RRF_IR_CONCURRENT           = 1 << 12,
4611 	NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40MINUS            = 1 << 13,
4612 	NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40PLUS             = 1 << 14,
4613 	NL80211_RRF_NO_80MHZ                = 1 << 15,
4614 	NL80211_RRF_NO_160MHZ               = 1 << 16,
4615 	NL80211_RRF_NO_HE                   = 1 << 17,
4616 	NL80211_RRF_NO_320MHZ               = 1 << 18,
4617 	NL80211_RRF_NO_EHT                  = 1 << 19,
4618 	NL80211_RRF_PSD                     = 1 << 20,
4619 	NL80211_RRF_DFS_CONCURRENT          = 1 << 21,
4620 	NL80211_RRF_NO_6GHZ_VLP_CLIENT      = 1 << 22,
4621 	NL80211_RRF_NO_6GHZ_AFC_CLIENT      = 1 << 23,
4622 	NL80211_RRF_ALLOW_6GHZ_VLP_AP       = 1 << 24,
4623 	NL80211_RRF_ALLOW_20MHZ_ACTIVITY    = 1 << 25,
4624 };
4625 
4626 #define NL80211_RRF_PASSIVE_SCAN	NL80211_RRF_NO_IR
4627 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_IBSS		NL80211_RRF_NO_IR
4628 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_IR		NL80211_RRF_NO_IR
4629 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40		(NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40MINUS |\
4630 					 NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40PLUS)
4631 #define NL80211_RRF_GO_CONCURRENT	NL80211_RRF_IR_CONCURRENT
4632 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_UHB_VLP_CLIENT	NL80211_RRF_NO_6GHZ_VLP_CLIENT
4633 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_UHB_AFC_CLIENT	NL80211_RRF_NO_6GHZ_AFC_CLIENT
4634 
4635 /* For backport compatibility with older userspace */
4636 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_IR_ALL		(NL80211_RRF_NO_IR | __NL80211_RRF_NO_IBSS)
4637 
4638 /**
4639  * enum nl80211_dfs_regions - regulatory DFS regions
4640  *
4641  * @NL80211_DFS_UNSET: Country has no DFS master region specified
4642  * @NL80211_DFS_FCC: Country follows DFS master rules from FCC
4643  * @NL80211_DFS_ETSI: Country follows DFS master rules from ETSI
4644  * @NL80211_DFS_JP: Country follows DFS master rules from JP/MKK/Telec
4645  */
4646 enum nl80211_dfs_regions {
4647 	NL80211_DFS_UNSET	= 0,
4648 	NL80211_DFS_FCC		= 1,
4649 	NL80211_DFS_ETSI	= 2,
4650 	NL80211_DFS_JP		= 3,
4651 };
4652 
4653 /**
4654  * enum nl80211_user_reg_hint_type - type of user regulatory hint
4655  *
4656  * @NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_USER: a user sent the hint. This is always
4657  *	assumed if the attribute is not set.
4658  * @NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_CELL_BASE: the hint comes from a cellular
4659  *	base station. Device drivers that have been tested to work
4660  *	properly to support this type of hint can enable these hints
4661  *	by setting the NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS feature
4662  *	capability on the struct wiphy. The wireless core will
4663  *	ignore all cell base station hints until at least one device
4664  *	present has been registered with the wireless core that
4665  *	has listed NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS as a
4666  *	supported feature.
4667  * @NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_INDOOR: a user sent an hint indicating that the
4668  *	platform is operating in an indoor environment.
4669  */
4670 enum nl80211_user_reg_hint_type {
4671 	NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_USER	= 0,
4672 	NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_CELL_BASE = 1,
4673 	NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_INDOOR    = 2,
4674 };
4675 
4676 /**
4677  * enum nl80211_survey_info - survey information
4678  *
4679  * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_INFO
4680  * when getting information about a survey.
4681  *
4682  * @__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4683  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY: center frequency of channel
4684  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_NOISE: noise level of channel (u8, dBm)
4685  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE: channel is currently being used
4686  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME: amount of time (in ms) that the radio
4687  *	was turned on (on channel or globally)
4688  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY: amount of the time the primary
4689  *	channel was sensed busy (either due to activity or energy detect)
4690  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY: amount of time the extension
4691  *	channel was sensed busy
4692  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX: amount of time the radio spent
4693  *	receiving data (on channel or globally)
4694  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX: amount of time the radio spent
4695  *	transmitting data (on channel or globally)
4696  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN: time the radio spent for scan
4697  *	(on this channel or globally)
4698  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
4699  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX: amount of time the radio spent
4700  *	receiving frames destined to the local BSS
4701  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_MAX: highest survey info attribute number
4702  *	currently defined
4703  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY_OFFSET: center frequency offset in KHz
4704  * @__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4705  */
4706 enum nl80211_survey_info {
4707 	__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_INVALID,
4708 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY,
4709 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_NOISE,
4710 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE,
4711 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME,
4712 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY,
4713 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY,
4714 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX,
4715 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX,
4716 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN,
4717 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_PAD,
4718 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX,
4719 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY_OFFSET,
4720 
4721 	/* keep last */
4722 	__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_AFTER_LAST,
4723 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1
4724 };
4725 
4726 /* keep old names for compatibility */
4727 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME		NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME
4728 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_BUSY		NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY
4729 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_EXT_BUSY	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY
4730 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_RX		NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX
4731 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_TX		NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX
4732 
4733 /**
4734  * enum nl80211_mntr_flags - monitor configuration flags
4735  *
4736  * Monitor configuration flags.
4737  *
4738  * @__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID: reserved
4739  *
4740  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL: pass frames with bad FCS
4741  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with bad PLCP
4742  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL: pass control frames
4743  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS: disable BSSID filtering
4744  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES: deprecated
4745  *	will unconditionally be refused
4746  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE: use the configured MAC address
4747  *	and ACK incoming unicast packets.
4748  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_SKIP_TX: do not pass local tx packets
4749  *
4750  * @__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4751  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_MAX: highest possible monitor flag
4752  */
4753 enum nl80211_mntr_flags {
4754 	__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID,
4755 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL,
4756 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL,
4757 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL,
4758 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS,
4759 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES,
4760 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE,
4761 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_SKIP_TX,
4762 
4763 	/* keep last */
4764 	__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_AFTER_LAST,
4765 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_MAX = __NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_AFTER_LAST - 1
4766 };
4767 
4768 /**
4769  * enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode - mesh power save modes
4770  *
4771  * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_UNKNOWN: The mesh power mode of the mesh STA is
4772  *	not known or has not been set yet.
4773  * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_ACTIVE: Active mesh power mode. The mesh STA is
4774  *	in Awake state all the time.
4775  * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_LIGHT_SLEEP: Light sleep mode. The mesh STA will
4776  *	alternate between Active and Doze states, but will wake up for
4777  *	neighbor's beacons.
4778  * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_DEEP_SLEEP: Deep sleep mode. The mesh STA will
4779  *	alternate between Active and Doze states, but may not wake up
4780  *	for neighbor's beacons.
4781  *
4782  * @__NL80211_MESH_POWER_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4783  * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_MAX: highest possible power save level
4784  */
4785 
4786 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode {
4787 	NL80211_MESH_POWER_UNKNOWN,
4788 	NL80211_MESH_POWER_ACTIVE,
4789 	NL80211_MESH_POWER_LIGHT_SLEEP,
4790 	NL80211_MESH_POWER_DEEP_SLEEP,
4791 
4792 	__NL80211_MESH_POWER_AFTER_LAST,
4793 	NL80211_MESH_POWER_MAX = __NL80211_MESH_POWER_AFTER_LAST - 1
4794 };
4795 
4796 /**
4797  * enum nl80211_meshconf_params - mesh configuration parameters
4798  *
4799  * Mesh configuration parameters. These can be changed while the mesh is
4800  * active.
4801  *
4802  * @__NL80211_MESHCONF_INVALID: internal use
4803  *
4804  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_RETRY_TIMEOUT: specifies the initial retry timeout in
4805  *	millisecond units, used by the Peer Link Open message
4806  *
4807  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_CONFIRM_TIMEOUT: specifies the initial confirm timeout, in
4808  *	millisecond units, used by the peer link management to close a peer link
4809  *
4810  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HOLDING_TIMEOUT: specifies the holding timeout, in
4811  *	millisecond units
4812  *
4813  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_PEER_LINKS: maximum number of peer links allowed
4814  *	on this mesh interface
4815  *
4816  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_RETRIES: specifies the maximum number of peer link
4817  *	open retries that can be sent to establish a new peer link instance in a
4818  *	mesh
4819  *
4820  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_TTL: specifies the value of TTL field set at a source mesh
4821  *	point.
4822  *
4823  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_AUTO_OPEN_PLINKS: whether we should automatically open
4824  *	peer links when we detect compatible mesh peers. Disabled if
4825  *	@NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM or @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE are
4826  *	set.
4827  *
4828  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_MAX_PREQ_RETRIES: the number of action frames
4829  *	containing a PREQ that an MP can send to a particular destination (path
4830  *	target)
4831  *
4832  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_PATH_REFRESH_TIME: how frequently to refresh mesh paths
4833  *	(in milliseconds)
4834  *
4835  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_MIN_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: minimum length of time to wait
4836  *	until giving up on a path discovery (in milliseconds)
4837  *
4838  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ACTIVE_PATH_TIMEOUT: The time (in TUs) for which mesh
4839  *	points receiving a PREQ shall consider the forwarding information from
4840  *	the root to be valid. (TU = time unit)
4841  *
4842  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PREQ_MIN_INTERVAL: The minimum interval of time (in
4843  *	TUs) during which an MP can send only one action frame containing a PREQ
4844  *	reference element
4845  *
4846  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_NET_DIAM_TRVS_TIME: The interval of time (in TUs)
4847  *	that it takes for an HWMP information element to propagate across the
4848  *	mesh
4849  *
4850  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOTMODE: whether root mode is enabled or not
4851  *
4852  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_ELEMENT_TTL: specifies the value of TTL field set at a
4853  *	source mesh point for path selection elements.
4854  *
4855  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_RANN_INTERVAL:  The interval of time (in TUs) between
4856  *	root announcements are transmitted.
4857  *
4858  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_GATE_ANNOUNCEMENTS: Advertise that this mesh station has
4859  *	access to a broader network beyond the MBSS.  This is done via Root
4860  *	Announcement frames.
4861  *
4862  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PERR_MIN_INTERVAL: The minimum interval of time (in
4863  *	TUs) during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing a
4864  *	PERR element.
4865  *
4866  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_FORWARDING: set Mesh STA as forwarding or non-forwarding
4867  *	or forwarding entity (default is TRUE - forwarding entity)
4868  *
4869  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_RSSI_THRESHOLD: RSSI threshold in dBm. This specifies the
4870  *	threshold for average signal strength of candidate station to establish
4871  *	a peer link.
4872  *
4873  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_SYNC_OFFSET_MAX_NEIGHBOR: maximum number of neighbors
4874  *	to synchronize to for 11s default synchronization method
4875  *	(see 11C.12.2.2)
4876  *
4877  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HT_OPMODE: set mesh HT protection mode.
4878  *
4879  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_MAX: highest possible mesh configuration attribute
4880  *
4881  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PATH_TO_ROOT_TIMEOUT: The time (in TUs) for
4882  *	which mesh STAs receiving a proactive PREQ shall consider the forwarding
4883  *	information to the root mesh STA to be valid.
4884  *
4885  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOT_INTERVAL: The interval of time (in TUs) between
4886  *	proactive PREQs are transmitted.
4887  *
4888  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_CONFIRMATION_INTERVAL: The minimum interval of time
4889  *	(in TUs) during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame
4890  *	containing a PREQ element for root path confirmation.
4891  *
4892  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_POWER_MODE: Default mesh power mode for new peer links.
4893  *	type &enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode (u32)
4894  *
4895  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_AWAKE_WINDOW: awake window duration (in TUs)
4896  *
4897  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_PLINK_TIMEOUT: If no tx activity is seen from a STA we've
4898  *	established peering with for longer than this time (in seconds), then
4899  *	remove it from the STA's list of peers. You may set this to 0 to disable
4900  *	the removal of the STA. Default is 30 minutes.
4901  *
4902  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_GATE: If set to true then this mesh STA
4903  *	will advertise that it is connected to a gate in the mesh formation
4904  *	field.  If left unset then the mesh formation field will only
4905  *	advertise such if there is an active root mesh path.
4906  *
4907  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_NOLEARN: Try to avoid multi-hop path discovery (e.g.
4908  *      PREQ/PREP for HWMP) if the destination is a direct neighbor. Note that
4909  *      this might not be the optimal decision as a multi-hop route might be
4910  *      better. So if using this setting you will likely also want to disable
4911  *      dot11MeshForwarding and use another mesh routing protocol on top.
4912  *
4913  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_AS: If set to true then this mesh STA
4914  *	will advertise that it is connected to a authentication server
4915  *	in the mesh formation field.
4916  *
4917  * @__NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4918  */
4919 enum nl80211_meshconf_params {
4920 	__NL80211_MESHCONF_INVALID,
4921 	NL80211_MESHCONF_RETRY_TIMEOUT,
4922 	NL80211_MESHCONF_CONFIRM_TIMEOUT,
4923 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HOLDING_TIMEOUT,
4924 	NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_PEER_LINKS,
4925 	NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_RETRIES,
4926 	NL80211_MESHCONF_TTL,
4927 	NL80211_MESHCONF_AUTO_OPEN_PLINKS,
4928 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_MAX_PREQ_RETRIES,
4929 	NL80211_MESHCONF_PATH_REFRESH_TIME,
4930 	NL80211_MESHCONF_MIN_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT,
4931 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ACTIVE_PATH_TIMEOUT,
4932 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PREQ_MIN_INTERVAL,
4933 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_NET_DIAM_TRVS_TIME,
4934 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOTMODE,
4935 	NL80211_MESHCONF_ELEMENT_TTL,
4936 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_RANN_INTERVAL,
4937 	NL80211_MESHCONF_GATE_ANNOUNCEMENTS,
4938 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PERR_MIN_INTERVAL,
4939 	NL80211_MESHCONF_FORWARDING,
4940 	NL80211_MESHCONF_RSSI_THRESHOLD,
4941 	NL80211_MESHCONF_SYNC_OFFSET_MAX_NEIGHBOR,
4942 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HT_OPMODE,
4943 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PATH_TO_ROOT_TIMEOUT,
4944 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOT_INTERVAL,
4945 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_CONFIRMATION_INTERVAL,
4946 	NL80211_MESHCONF_POWER_MODE,
4947 	NL80211_MESHCONF_AWAKE_WINDOW,
4948 	NL80211_MESHCONF_PLINK_TIMEOUT,
4949 	NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_GATE,
4950 	NL80211_MESHCONF_NOLEARN,
4951 	NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_AS,
4952 
4953 	/* keep last */
4954 	__NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4955 	NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4956 };
4957 
4958 /**
4959  * enum nl80211_mesh_setup_params - mesh setup parameters
4960  *
4961  * Mesh setup parameters.  These are used to start/join a mesh and cannot be
4962  * changed while the mesh is active.
4963  *
4964  * @__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_INVALID: Internal use
4965  *
4966  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_PATH_SEL: Enable this option to use a
4967  *	vendor specific path selection algorithm or disable it to use the
4968  *	default HWMP.
4969  *
4970  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_METRIC: Enable this option to use a
4971  *	vendor specific path metric or disable it to use the default Airtime
4972  *	metric.
4973  *
4974  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_IE: Information elements for this mesh, for instance, a
4975  *	robust security network ie, or a vendor specific information element
4976  *	that vendors will use to identify the path selection methods and
4977  *	metrics in use.
4978  *
4979  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH: Enable this option if an authentication
4980  *	daemon will be authenticating mesh candidates.
4981  *
4982  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE: Enable this option if an authentication
4983  *	daemon will be securing peer link frames.  AMPE is a secured version of
4984  *	Mesh Peering Management (MPM) and is implemented with the assistance of
4985  *	a userspace daemon.  When this flag is set, the kernel will send peer
4986  *	management frames to a userspace daemon that will implement AMPE
4987  *	functionality (security capabilities selection, key confirmation, and
4988  *	key management).  When the flag is unset (default), the kernel can
4989  *	autonomously complete (unsecured) mesh peering without the need of a
4990  *	userspace daemon.
4991  *
4992  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_SYNC: Enable this option to use a
4993  *	vendor specific synchronization method or disable it to use the default
4994  *	neighbor offset synchronization
4995  *
4996  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM: Enable this option if userspace will
4997  *	implement an MPM which handles peer allocation and state.
4998  *
4999  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_AUTH_PROTOCOL: Inform the kernel of the authentication
5000  *	method (u8, as defined in IEEE 8.4.2.100.6, e.g. 0x1 for SAE).
5001  *	Default is no authentication method required.
5002  *
5003  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_MAX: highest possible mesh setup attribute number
5004  *
5005  * @__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: Internal use
5006  */
5007 enum nl80211_mesh_setup_params {
5008 	__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_INVALID,
5009 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_PATH_SEL,
5010 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_METRIC,
5011 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_IE,
5012 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH,
5013 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE,
5014 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_SYNC,
5015 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM,
5016 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_AUTH_PROTOCOL,
5017 
5018 	/* keep last */
5019 	__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
5020 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
5021 };
5022 
5023 /**
5024  * enum nl80211_txq_attr - TX queue parameter attributes
5025  * @__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_INVALID: Attribute number 0 is reserved
5026  * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AC: AC identifier (NL80211_AC_*)
5027  * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_TXOP: Maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning
5028  *	disabled
5029  * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMIN: Minimum contention window [a value of the form
5030  *	2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
5031  * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMAX: Maximum contention window [a value of the form
5032  *	2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
5033  * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AIFS: Arbitration interframe space [0..255]
5034  * @__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: Internal
5035  * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_MAX: Maximum TXQ attribute number
5036  */
5037 enum nl80211_txq_attr {
5038 	__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_INVALID,
5039 	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AC,
5040 	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_TXOP,
5041 	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMIN,
5042 	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMAX,
5043 	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AIFS,
5044 
5045 	/* keep last */
5046 	__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
5047 	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
5048 };
5049 
5050 enum nl80211_ac {
5051 	NL80211_AC_VO,
5052 	NL80211_AC_VI,
5053 	NL80211_AC_BE,
5054 	NL80211_AC_BK,
5055 	NL80211_NUM_ACS
5056 };
5057 
5058 /* backward compat */
5059 #define NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_QUEUE	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AC
5060 #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_VO	NL80211_AC_VO
5061 #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_VI	NL80211_AC_VI
5062 #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_BE	NL80211_AC_BE
5063 #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_BK	NL80211_AC_BK
5064 
5065 /**
5066  * enum nl80211_channel_type - channel type
5067  * @NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT: 20 MHz, non-HT channel
5068  * @NL80211_CHAN_HT20: 20 MHz HT channel
5069  * @NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS: HT40 channel, secondary channel
5070  *	below the control channel
5071  * @NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS: HT40 channel, secondary channel
5072  *	above the control channel
5073  */
5074 enum nl80211_channel_type {
5075 	NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT,
5076 	NL80211_CHAN_HT20,
5077 	NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS,
5078 	NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS
5079 };
5080 
5081 /**
5082  * enum nl80211_key_mode - Key mode
5083  *
5084  * @NL80211_KEY_RX_TX: (Default)
5085  *	Key can be used for Rx and Tx immediately
5086  *
5087  * The following modes can only be selected for unicast keys and when the
5088  * driver supports @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_EXT_KEY_ID:
5089  *
5090  * @NL80211_KEY_NO_TX: Only allowed in combination with @NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY:
5091  *	Unicast key can only be used for Rx, Tx not allowed, yet
5092  * @NL80211_KEY_SET_TX: Only allowed in combination with @NL80211_CMD_SET_KEY:
5093  *	The unicast key identified by idx and mac is cleared for Tx and becomes
5094  *	the preferred Tx key for the station.
5095  */
5096 enum nl80211_key_mode {
5097 	NL80211_KEY_RX_TX,
5098 	NL80211_KEY_NO_TX,
5099 	NL80211_KEY_SET_TX
5100 };
5101 
5102 /**
5103  * enum nl80211_chan_width - channel width definitions
5104  *
5105  * These values are used with the %NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH
5106  * attribute.
5107  *
5108  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT: 20 MHz, non-HT channel
5109  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20: 20 MHz HT channel
5110  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40: 40 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
5111  *	attribute must be provided as well
5112  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80: 80 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
5113  *	attribute must be provided as well
5114  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80P80: 80+80 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
5115  *	and %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2 attributes must be provided as well
5116  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_160: 160 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
5117  *	attribute must be provided as well
5118  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5: 5 MHz OFDM channel
5119  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10: 10 MHz OFDM channel
5120  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_1: 1 MHz OFDM channel
5121  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_2: 2 MHz OFDM channel
5122  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_4: 4 MHz OFDM channel
5123  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_8: 8 MHz OFDM channel
5124  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_16: 16 MHz OFDM channel
5125  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_320: 320 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
5126  *	attribute must be provided as well
5127  */
5128 enum nl80211_chan_width {
5129 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT,
5130 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20,
5131 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40,
5132 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80,
5133 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80P80,
5134 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_160,
5135 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5,
5136 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10,
5137 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_1,
5138 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_2,
5139 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_4,
5140 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_8,
5141 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_16,
5142 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_320,
5143 };
5144 
5145 /**
5146  * enum nl80211_bss_scan_width - control channel width for a BSS
5147  *
5148  * These values are used with the %NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH attribute.
5149  *
5150  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20: control channel is 20 MHz wide or compatible
5151  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_10: control channel is 10 MHz wide
5152  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_5: control channel is 5 MHz wide
5153  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_1: control channel is 1 MHz wide
5154  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_2: control channel is 2 MHz wide
5155  */
5156 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width {
5157 	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20,
5158 	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_10,
5159 	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_5,
5160 	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_1,
5161 	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_2,
5162 };
5163 
5164 /**
5165  * enum nl80211_bss_use_for - bitmap indicating possible BSS use
5166  * @NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_NORMAL: Use this BSS for normal "connection",
5167  *	including IBSS/MBSS depending on the type.
5168  * @NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_MLD_LINK: This BSS can be used as a link in an
5169  *	MLO connection. Note that for an MLO connection, all links including
5170  *	the assoc link must have this flag set, and the assoc link must
5171  *	additionally have %NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_NORMAL set.
5172  */
5173 enum nl80211_bss_use_for {
5174 	NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_NORMAL = 1 << 0,
5175 	NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_MLD_LINK = 1 << 1,
5176 };
5177 
5178 /**
5179  * enum nl80211_bss_cannot_use_reasons - reason(s) connection to a
5180  *	BSS isn't possible
5181  * @NL80211_BSS_CANNOT_USE_NSTR_NONPRIMARY: NSTR nonprimary links aren't
5182  *	supported by the device, and this BSS entry represents one.
5183  * @NL80211_BSS_CANNOT_USE_6GHZ_PWR_MISMATCH: STA is not supporting
5184  *	the AP power type (SP, VLP, AP) that the AP uses.
5185  */
5186 enum nl80211_bss_cannot_use_reasons {
5187 	NL80211_BSS_CANNOT_USE_NSTR_NONPRIMARY	= 1 << 0,
5188 	NL80211_BSS_CANNOT_USE_6GHZ_PWR_MISMATCH	= 1 << 1,
5189 };
5190 
5191 #define NL80211_BSS_CANNOT_USE_UHB_PWR_MISMATCH \
5192 	NL80211_BSS_CANNOT_USE_6GHZ_PWR_MISMATCH
5193 
5194 /**
5195  * enum nl80211_bss - netlink attributes for a BSS
5196  *
5197  * @__NL80211_BSS_INVALID: invalid
5198  * @NL80211_BSS_BSSID: BSSID of the BSS (6 octets)
5199  * @NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY: frequency in MHz (u32)
5200  * @NL80211_BSS_TSF: TSF of the received probe response/beacon (u64)
5201  *	(if @NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA is present then this is known to be
5202  *	from a probe response, otherwise it may be from the same beacon
5203  *	that the NL80211_BSS_BEACON_TSF will be from)
5204  * @NL80211_BSS_BEACON_INTERVAL: beacon interval of the (I)BSS (u16)
5205  * @NL80211_BSS_CAPABILITY: capability field (CPU order, u16)
5206  * @NL80211_BSS_INFORMATION_ELEMENTS: binary attribute containing the
5207  *	raw information elements from the probe response/beacon (bin);
5208  *	if the %NL80211_BSS_BEACON_IES attribute is present and the data is
5209  *	different then the IEs here are from a Probe Response frame; otherwise
5210  *	they are from a Beacon frame.
5211  *	However, if the driver does not indicate the source of the IEs, these
5212  *	IEs may be from either frame subtype.
5213  *	If present, the @NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA attribute indicates that the
5214  *	data here is known to be from a probe response, without any heuristics.
5215  * @NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_MBM: signal strength of probe response/beacon
5216  *	in mBm (100 * dBm) (s32)
5217  * @NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_UNSPEC: signal strength of the probe response/beacon
5218  *	in unspecified units, scaled to 0..100 (u8)
5219  * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS: status, if this BSS is "used"
5220  * @NL80211_BSS_SEEN_MS_AGO: age of this BSS entry in ms
5221  * @NL80211_BSS_BEACON_IES: binary attribute containing the raw information
5222  *	elements from a Beacon frame (bin); not present if no Beacon frame has
5223  *	yet been received
5224  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH: channel width of the control channel
5225  *	(u32, enum nl80211_bss_scan_width) - No longer used!
5226  * @NL80211_BSS_BEACON_TSF: TSF of the last received beacon (u64)
5227  *	(not present if no beacon frame has been received yet)
5228  * @NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA: the data in @NL80211_BSS_INFORMATION_ELEMENTS and
5229  *	@NL80211_BSS_TSF is known to be from a probe response (flag attribute)
5230  * @NL80211_BSS_LAST_SEEN_BOOTTIME: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp when this entry
5231  *	was last updated by a received frame. The value is expected to be
5232  *	accurate to about 10ms. (u64, nanoseconds)
5233  * @NL80211_BSS_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
5234  * @NL80211_BSS_PARENT_TSF: the time at the start of reception of the first
5235  *	octet of the timestamp field of the last beacon/probe received for
5236  *	this BSS. The time is the TSF of the BSS specified by
5237  *	@NL80211_BSS_PARENT_BSSID. (u64).
5238  * @NL80211_BSS_PARENT_BSSID: the BSS according to which @NL80211_BSS_PARENT_TSF
5239  *	is set.
5240  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAIN_SIGNAL: per-chain signal strength of last BSS update.
5241  *	Contains a nested array of signal strength attributes (u8, dBm),
5242  *	using the nesting index as the antenna number.
5243  * @NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY_OFFSET: frequency offset in KHz
5244  * @NL80211_BSS_MLO_LINK_ID: MLO link ID of the BSS (u8).
5245  * @NL80211_BSS_MLD_ADDR: MLD address of this BSS if connected to it.
5246  * @NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR: u32 bitmap attribute indicating what the BSS can be
5247  *	used for, see &enum nl80211_bss_use_for.
5248  * @NL80211_BSS_CANNOT_USE_REASONS: Indicates the reason that this BSS cannot
5249  *	be used for all or some of the possible uses by the device reporting it,
5250  *	even though its presence was detected.
5251  *	This is a u64 attribute containing a bitmap of values from
5252  *	&enum nl80211_cannot_use_reasons, note that the attribute may be missing
5253  *	if no reasons are specified.
5254  * @__NL80211_BSS_AFTER_LAST: internal
5255  * @NL80211_BSS_MAX: highest BSS attribute
5256  */
5257 enum nl80211_bss {
5258 	__NL80211_BSS_INVALID,
5259 	NL80211_BSS_BSSID,
5260 	NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY,
5261 	NL80211_BSS_TSF,
5262 	NL80211_BSS_BEACON_INTERVAL,
5263 	NL80211_BSS_CAPABILITY,
5264 	NL80211_BSS_INFORMATION_ELEMENTS,
5265 	NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_MBM,
5266 	NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_UNSPEC,
5267 	NL80211_BSS_STATUS,
5268 	NL80211_BSS_SEEN_MS_AGO,
5269 	NL80211_BSS_BEACON_IES,
5270 	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH,
5271 	NL80211_BSS_BEACON_TSF,
5272 	NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA,
5273 	NL80211_BSS_LAST_SEEN_BOOTTIME,
5274 	NL80211_BSS_PAD,
5275 	NL80211_BSS_PARENT_TSF,
5276 	NL80211_BSS_PARENT_BSSID,
5277 	NL80211_BSS_CHAIN_SIGNAL,
5278 	NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY_OFFSET,
5279 	NL80211_BSS_MLO_LINK_ID,
5280 	NL80211_BSS_MLD_ADDR,
5281 	NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR,
5282 	NL80211_BSS_CANNOT_USE_REASONS,
5283 
5284 	/* keep last */
5285 	__NL80211_BSS_AFTER_LAST,
5286 	NL80211_BSS_MAX = __NL80211_BSS_AFTER_LAST - 1
5287 };
5288 
5289 /**
5290  * enum nl80211_bss_status - BSS "status"
5291  * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS_AUTHENTICATED: Authenticated with this BSS.
5292  *	Note that this is no longer used since cfg80211 no longer
5293  *	keeps track of whether or not authentication was done with
5294  *	a given BSS.
5295  * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS_ASSOCIATED: Associated with this BSS.
5296  * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS_IBSS_JOINED: Joined to this IBSS.
5297  *
5298  * The BSS status is a BSS attribute in scan dumps, which
5299  * indicates the status the interface has wrt. this BSS.
5300  */
5301 enum nl80211_bss_status {
5302 	NL80211_BSS_STATUS_AUTHENTICATED,
5303 	NL80211_BSS_STATUS_ASSOCIATED,
5304 	NL80211_BSS_STATUS_IBSS_JOINED,
5305 };
5306 
5307 /**
5308  * enum nl80211_auth_type - AuthenticationType
5309  *
5310  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_OPEN_SYSTEM: Open System authentication
5311  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SHARED_KEY: Shared Key authentication (WEP only)
5312  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FT: Fast BSS Transition (IEEE 802.11r)
5313  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NETWORK_EAP: Network EAP (some Cisco APs and mainly LEAP)
5314  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SAE: Simultaneous authentication of equals
5315  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK: Fast Initial Link Setup shared key
5316  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK_PFS: Fast Initial Link Setup shared key with PFS
5317  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_PK: Fast Initial Link Setup public key
5318  * @__NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NUM: internal
5319  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_MAX: maximum valid auth algorithm
5320  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_AUTOMATIC: determine automatically (if necessary by
5321  *	trying multiple times); this is invalid in netlink -- leave out
5322  *	the attribute for this on CONNECT commands.
5323  */
5324 enum nl80211_auth_type {
5325 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_OPEN_SYSTEM,
5326 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SHARED_KEY,
5327 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FT,
5328 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NETWORK_EAP,
5329 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SAE,
5330 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK,
5331 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK_PFS,
5332 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_PK,
5333 
5334 	/* keep last */
5335 	__NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NUM,
5336 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_MAX = __NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NUM - 1,
5337 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_AUTOMATIC
5338 };
5339 
5340 /**
5341  * enum nl80211_key_type - Key Type
5342  * @NL80211_KEYTYPE_GROUP: Group (broadcast/multicast) key
5343  * @NL80211_KEYTYPE_PAIRWISE: Pairwise (unicast/individual) key
5344  * @NL80211_KEYTYPE_PEERKEY: PeerKey (DLS)
5345  * @NUM_NL80211_KEYTYPES: number of defined key types
5346  */
5347 enum nl80211_key_type {
5348 	NL80211_KEYTYPE_GROUP,
5349 	NL80211_KEYTYPE_PAIRWISE,
5350 	NL80211_KEYTYPE_PEERKEY,
5351 
5352 	NUM_NL80211_KEYTYPES
5353 };
5354 
5355 /**
5356  * enum nl80211_mfp - Management frame protection state
5357  * @NL80211_MFP_NO: Management frame protection not used
5358  * @NL80211_MFP_REQUIRED: Management frame protection required
5359  * @NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL: Management frame protection is optional
5360  */
5361 enum nl80211_mfp {
5362 	NL80211_MFP_NO,
5363 	NL80211_MFP_REQUIRED,
5364 	NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL,
5365 };
5366 
5367 enum nl80211_wpa_versions {
5368 	NL80211_WPA_VERSION_1 = 1 << 0,
5369 	NL80211_WPA_VERSION_2 = 1 << 1,
5370 	NL80211_WPA_VERSION_3 = 1 << 2,
5371 };
5372 
5373 /**
5374  * enum nl80211_key_default_types - key default types
5375  * @__NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_INVALID: invalid
5376  * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_UNICAST: key should be used as default
5377  *	unicast key
5378  * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_MULTICAST: key should be used as default
5379  *	multicast key
5380  * @NUM_NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES: number of default types
5381  */
5382 enum nl80211_key_default_types {
5383 	__NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_INVALID,
5384 	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_UNICAST,
5385 	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_MULTICAST,
5386 
5387 	NUM_NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES
5388 };
5389 
5390 /**
5391  * enum nl80211_key_attributes - key attributes
5392  * @__NL80211_KEY_INVALID: invalid
5393  * @NL80211_KEY_DATA: (temporal) key data; for TKIP this consists of
5394  *	16 bytes encryption key followed by 8 bytes each for TX and RX MIC
5395  *	keys
5396  * @NL80211_KEY_IDX: key ID (u8, 0-3)
5397  * @NL80211_KEY_CIPHER: key cipher suite (u32, as defined by IEEE 802.11
5398  *	section 7.3.2.25.1, e.g. 0x000FAC04)
5399  * @NL80211_KEY_SEQ: transmit key sequence number (IV/PN) for TKIP and
5400  *	CCMP keys, each six bytes in little endian
5401  * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT: flag indicating default key
5402  * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT: flag indicating default management key
5403  * @NL80211_KEY_TYPE: the key type from enum nl80211_key_type, if not
5404  *	specified the default depends on whether a MAC address was
5405  *	given with the command using the key or not (u32)
5406  * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES: A nested attribute containing flags
5407  *	attributes, specifying what a key should be set as default as.
5408  *	See &enum nl80211_key_default_types.
5409  * @NL80211_KEY_MODE: the mode from enum nl80211_key_mode.
5410  *	Defaults to @NL80211_KEY_RX_TX.
5411  * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_BEACON: flag indicating default Beacon frame key
5412  *
5413  * @__NL80211_KEY_AFTER_LAST: internal
5414  * @NL80211_KEY_MAX: highest key attribute
5415  */
5416 enum nl80211_key_attributes {
5417 	__NL80211_KEY_INVALID,
5418 	NL80211_KEY_DATA,
5419 	NL80211_KEY_IDX,
5420 	NL80211_KEY_CIPHER,
5421 	NL80211_KEY_SEQ,
5422 	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT,
5423 	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT,
5424 	NL80211_KEY_TYPE,
5425 	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES,
5426 	NL80211_KEY_MODE,
5427 	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_BEACON,
5428 
5429 	/* keep last */
5430 	__NL80211_KEY_AFTER_LAST,
5431 	NL80211_KEY_MAX = __NL80211_KEY_AFTER_LAST - 1
5432 };
5433 
5434 /**
5435  * enum nl80211_tx_rate_attributes - TX rate set attributes
5436  * @__NL80211_TXRATE_INVALID: invalid
5437  * @NL80211_TXRATE_LEGACY: Legacy (non-MCS) rates allowed for TX rate selection
5438  *	in an array of rates as defined in IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 (u8 values with
5439  *	1 = 500 kbps) but without the IE length restriction (at most
5440  *	%NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES in a single array).
5441  * @NL80211_TXRATE_HT: HT (MCS) rates allowed for TX rate selection
5442  *	in an array of MCS numbers.
5443  * @NL80211_TXRATE_VHT: VHT rates allowed for TX rate selection,
5444  *	see &struct nl80211_txrate_vht
5445  * @NL80211_TXRATE_GI: configure GI, see &enum nl80211_txrate_gi
5446  * @NL80211_TXRATE_HE: HE rates allowed for TX rate selection,
5447  *	see &struct nl80211_txrate_he
5448  * @NL80211_TXRATE_HE_GI: configure HE GI, 0.8us, 1.6us and 3.2us.
5449  * @NL80211_TXRATE_HE_LTF: configure HE LTF, 1XLTF, 2XLTF and 4XLTF.
5450  * @__NL80211_TXRATE_AFTER_LAST: internal
5451  * @NL80211_TXRATE_MAX: highest TX rate attribute
5452  */
5453 enum nl80211_tx_rate_attributes {
5454 	__NL80211_TXRATE_INVALID,
5455 	NL80211_TXRATE_LEGACY,
5456 	NL80211_TXRATE_HT,
5457 	NL80211_TXRATE_VHT,
5458 	NL80211_TXRATE_GI,
5459 	NL80211_TXRATE_HE,
5460 	NL80211_TXRATE_HE_GI,
5461 	NL80211_TXRATE_HE_LTF,
5462 
5463 	/* keep last */
5464 	__NL80211_TXRATE_AFTER_LAST,
5465 	NL80211_TXRATE_MAX = __NL80211_TXRATE_AFTER_LAST - 1
5466 };
5467 
5468 #define NL80211_TXRATE_MCS NL80211_TXRATE_HT
5469 #define NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX		8
5470 
5471 /**
5472  * struct nl80211_txrate_vht - VHT MCS/NSS txrate bitmap
5473  * @mcs: MCS bitmap table for each NSS (array index 0 for 1 stream, etc.)
5474  */
5475 struct nl80211_txrate_vht {
5476 	__u16 mcs[NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX];
5477 };
5478 
5479 #define NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX		8
5480 /**
5481  * struct nl80211_txrate_he - HE MCS/NSS txrate bitmap
5482  * @mcs: MCS bitmap table for each NSS (array index 0 for 1 stream, etc.)
5483  */
5484 struct nl80211_txrate_he {
5485 	__u16 mcs[NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX];
5486 };
5487 
5488 enum nl80211_txrate_gi {
5489 	NL80211_TXRATE_DEFAULT_GI,
5490 	NL80211_TXRATE_FORCE_SGI,
5491 	NL80211_TXRATE_FORCE_LGI,
5492 };
5493 
5494 /**
5495  * enum nl80211_band - Frequency band
5496  * @NL80211_BAND_2GHZ: 2.4 GHz ISM band
5497  * @NL80211_BAND_5GHZ: around 5 GHz band (4.9 - 5.7 GHz)
5498  * @NL80211_BAND_60GHZ: around 60 GHz band (58.32 - 69.12 GHz)
5499  * @NL80211_BAND_6GHZ: around 6 GHz band (5.9 - 7.2 GHz)
5500  * @NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ: around 900MHz, supported by S1G PHYs
5501  * @NL80211_BAND_LC: light communication band (placeholder)
5502  * @NUM_NL80211_BANDS: number of bands, avoid using this in userspace
5503  *	since newer kernel versions may support more bands
5504  */
5505 enum nl80211_band {
5506 	NL80211_BAND_2GHZ,
5507 	NL80211_BAND_5GHZ,
5508 	NL80211_BAND_60GHZ,
5509 	NL80211_BAND_6GHZ,
5510 	NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ,
5511 	NL80211_BAND_LC,
5512 
5513 	NUM_NL80211_BANDS,
5514 };
5515 
5516 /**
5517  * enum nl80211_ps_state - powersave state
5518  * @NL80211_PS_DISABLED: powersave is disabled
5519  * @NL80211_PS_ENABLED: powersave is enabled
5520  */
5521 enum nl80211_ps_state {
5522 	NL80211_PS_DISABLED,
5523 	NL80211_PS_ENABLED,
5524 };
5525 
5526 /**
5527  * enum nl80211_attr_cqm - connection quality monitor attributes
5528  * @__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_INVALID: invalid
5529  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THOLD: RSSI threshold in dBm. This value specifies
5530  *	the threshold for the RSSI level at which an event will be sent. Zero
5531  *	to disable.  Alternatively, if %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST is
5532  *	set, multiple values can be supplied as a low-to-high sorted array of
5533  *	threshold values in dBm.  Events will be sent when the RSSI value
5534  *	crosses any of the thresholds.
5535  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_HYST: RSSI hysteresis in dBm. This value specifies
5536  *	the minimum amount the RSSI level must change after an event before a
5537  *	new event may be issued (to reduce effects of RSSI oscillation).
5538  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT: RSSI threshold event
5539  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_PKT_LOSS_EVENT: a u32 value indicating that this many
5540  *	consecutive packets were not acknowledged by the peer
5541  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE: TX error rate in %. Minimum % of TX failures
5542  *	during the given %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL before an
5543  *	%NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM with reported %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE and
5544  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS is generated.
5545  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS: number of attempted packets in a given
5546  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL before %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE is
5547  *	checked.
5548  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL: interval in seconds. Specifies the periodic
5549  *	interval in which %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS and
5550  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE must be satisfied before generating an
5551  *	%NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM. Set to 0 to turn off TX error reporting.
5552  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT: flag attribute that's set in a beacon
5553  *	loss event
5554  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_LEVEL: the RSSI value in dBm that triggered the
5555  *	RSSI threshold event.
5556  * @__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_AFTER_LAST: internal
5557  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_MAX: highest key attribute
5558  */
5559 enum nl80211_attr_cqm {
5560 	__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_INVALID,
5561 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THOLD,
5562 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_HYST,
5563 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT,
5564 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_PKT_LOSS_EVENT,
5565 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE,
5566 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS,
5567 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL,
5568 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT,
5569 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_LEVEL,
5570 
5571 	/* keep last */
5572 	__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_AFTER_LAST,
5573 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_MAX = __NL80211_ATTR_CQM_AFTER_LAST - 1
5574 };
5575 
5576 /**
5577  * enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event - RSSI threshold event
5578  * @NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_LOW: The RSSI level is lower than the
5579  *      configured threshold
5580  * @NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_HIGH: The RSSI is higher than the
5581  *      configured threshold
5582  * @NL80211_CQM_RSSI_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT: (reserved, never sent)
5583  */
5584 enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event {
5585 	NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_LOW,
5586 	NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_HIGH,
5587 	NL80211_CQM_RSSI_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT,
5588 };
5589 
5590 
5591 /**
5592  * enum nl80211_tx_power_setting - TX power adjustment
5593  * @NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC: automatically determine transmit power
5594  * @NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED: limit TX power by the mBm parameter
5595  * @NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED: fix TX power to the mBm parameter
5596  */
5597 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting {
5598 	NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC,
5599 	NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED,
5600 	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED,
5601 };
5602 
5603 /**
5604  * enum nl80211_tid_config - TID config state
5605  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ENABLE: Enable config for the TID
5606  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_DISABLE: Disable config for the TID
5607  */
5608 enum nl80211_tid_config {
5609 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ENABLE,
5610 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_DISABLE,
5611 };
5612 
5613 /* enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting - TX rate configuration type
5614  * @NL80211_TX_RATE_AUTOMATIC: automatically determine TX rate
5615  * @NL80211_TX_RATE_LIMITED: limit the TX rate by the TX rate parameter
5616  * @NL80211_TX_RATE_FIXED: fix TX rate to the TX rate parameter
5617  */
5618 enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting {
5619 	NL80211_TX_RATE_AUTOMATIC,
5620 	NL80211_TX_RATE_LIMITED,
5621 	NL80211_TX_RATE_FIXED,
5622 };
5623 
5624 /* enum nl80211_tid_config_attr - TID specific configuration.
5625  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PAD: pad attribute for 64-bit values
5626  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_VIF_SUPP: a bitmap (u64) of attributes supported
5627  *	for per-vif configuration; doesn't list the ones that are generic
5628  *	(%NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS, %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE).
5629  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PEER_SUPP: same as the previous per-vif one, but
5630  *	per peer instead.
5631  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE: flag attribute, if set indicates
5632  *	that the new configuration overrides all previous peer
5633  *	configurations, otherwise previous peer specific configurations
5634  *	should be left untouched.
5635  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS: a bitmask value of TIDs (bit 0 to 7)
5636  *	Its type is u16.
5637  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_NOACK: Configure ack policy for the TID.
5638  *	specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TID. see %enum nl80211_tid_config.
5639  *	Its type is u8.
5640  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT: Number of retries used with data frame
5641  *	transmission, user-space sets this configuration in
5642  *	&NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG. It is u8 type, min value is 1 and
5643  *	the max value is advertised by the driver in this attribute on
5644  *	output in wiphy capabilities.
5645  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG: Number of retries used with data frame
5646  *	transmission, user-space sets this configuration in
5647  *	&NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG. Its type is u8, min value is 1 and
5648  *	the max value is advertised by the driver in this attribute on
5649  *	output in wiphy capabilities.
5650  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMPDU_CTRL: Enable/Disable MPDU aggregation
5651  *	for the TIDs specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS.
5652  *	Its type is u8, using the values from &nl80211_tid_config.
5653  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RTSCTS_CTRL: Enable/Disable RTS_CTS for the TIDs
5654  *	specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS. It is u8 type, using
5655  *	the values from &nl80211_tid_config.
5656  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMSDU_CTRL: Enable/Disable MSDU aggregation
5657  *	for the TIDs specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS.
5658  *	Its type is u8, using the values from &nl80211_tid_config.
5659  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE_TYPE: This attribute will be useful
5660  *	to notfiy the driver that what type of txrate should be used
5661  *	for the TIDs specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS. using
5662  *	the values form &nl80211_tx_rate_setting.
5663  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE: Data frame TX rate mask should be applied
5664  *	with the parameters passed through %NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES.
5665  *	configuration is applied to the data frame for the tid to that connected
5666  *	station.
5667  */
5668 enum nl80211_tid_config_attr {
5669 	__NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_INVALID,
5670 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PAD,
5671 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_VIF_SUPP,
5672 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PEER_SUPP,
5673 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE,
5674 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS,
5675 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_NOACK,
5676 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT,
5677 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG,
5678 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMPDU_CTRL,
5679 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RTSCTS_CTRL,
5680 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMSDU_CTRL,
5681 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE_TYPE,
5682 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE,
5683 
5684 	/* keep last */
5685 	__NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
5686 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
5687 };
5688 
5689 /**
5690  * enum nl80211_packet_pattern_attr - packet pattern attribute
5691  * @__NL80211_PKTPAT_INVALID: invalid number for nested attribute
5692  * @NL80211_PKTPAT_PATTERN: the pattern, values where the mask has
5693  *	a zero bit are ignored
5694  * @NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK: pattern mask, must be long enough to have
5695  *	a bit for each byte in the pattern. The lowest-order bit corresponds
5696  *	to the first byte of the pattern, but the bytes of the pattern are
5697  *	in a little-endian-like format, i.e. the 9th byte of the pattern
5698  *	corresponds to the lowest-order bit in the second byte of the mask.
5699  *	For example: The match 00:xx:00:00:xx:00:00:00:00:xx:xx:xx (where
5700  *	xx indicates "don't care") would be represented by a pattern of
5701  *	twelve zero bytes, and a mask of "0xed,0x01".
5702  *	Note that the pattern matching is done as though frames were not
5703  *	802.11 frames but 802.3 frames, i.e. the frame is fully unpacked
5704  *	first (including SNAP header unpacking) and then matched.
5705  * @NL80211_PKTPAT_OFFSET: packet offset, pattern is matched after
5706  *	these fixed number of bytes of received packet
5707  * @NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT: number of attributes
5708  * @MAX_NL80211_PKTPAT: max attribute number
5709  */
5710 enum nl80211_packet_pattern_attr {
5711 	__NL80211_PKTPAT_INVALID,
5712 	NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK,
5713 	NL80211_PKTPAT_PATTERN,
5714 	NL80211_PKTPAT_OFFSET,
5715 
5716 	NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT,
5717 	MAX_NL80211_PKTPAT = NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT - 1,
5718 };
5719 
5720 /**
5721  * struct nl80211_pattern_support - packet pattern support information
5722  * @max_patterns: maximum number of patterns supported
5723  * @min_pattern_len: minimum length of each pattern
5724  * @max_pattern_len: maximum length of each pattern
5725  * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset
5726  *
5727  * This struct is carried in %NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_PKT_PATTERN when
5728  * that is part of %NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED or in
5729  * %NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_PKT_PATTERN when that is part of
5730  * %NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE in the capability information given
5731  * by the kernel to userspace.
5732  */
5733 struct nl80211_pattern_support {
5734 	__u32 max_patterns;
5735 	__u32 min_pattern_len;
5736 	__u32 max_pattern_len;
5737 	__u32 max_pkt_offset;
5738 } __attribute__((packed));
5739 
5740 /* only for backward compatibility */
5741 #define __NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_INVALID __NL80211_PKTPAT_INVALID
5742 #define NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_MASK NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK
5743 #define NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_PATTERN NL80211_PKTPAT_PATTERN
5744 #define NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_OFFSET NL80211_PKTPAT_OFFSET
5745 #define NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT
5746 #define MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT MAX_NL80211_PKTPAT
5747 #define nl80211_wowlan_pattern_support nl80211_pattern_support
5748 
5749 /**
5750  * enum nl80211_wowlan_triggers - WoWLAN trigger definitions
5751  * @__NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes
5752  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_ANY: wake up on any activity, do not really put
5753  *	the chip into a special state -- works best with chips that have
5754  *	support for low-power operation already (flag)
5755  *	Note that this mode is incompatible with all of the others, if
5756  *	any others are even supported by the device.
5757  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_DISCONNECT: wake up on disconnect, the way disconnect
5758  *	is detected is implementation-specific (flag)
5759  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_MAGIC_PKT: wake up on magic packet (6x 0xff, followed
5760  *	by 16 repetitions of MAC addr, anywhere in payload) (flag)
5761  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_PKT_PATTERN: wake up on the specified packet patterns
5762  *	which are passed in an array of nested attributes, each nested attribute
5763  *	defining a with attributes from &struct nl80211_wowlan_trig_pkt_pattern.
5764  *	Each pattern defines a wakeup packet. Packet offset is associated with
5765  *	each pattern which is used while matching the pattern. The matching is
5766  *	done on the MSDU, i.e. as though the packet was an 802.3 packet, so the
5767  *	pattern matching is done after the packet is converted to the MSDU.
5768  *
5769  *	In %NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED, it is a binary attribute
5770  *	carrying a &struct nl80211_pattern_support.
5771  *
5772  *	When reporting wakeup. it is a u32 attribute containing the 0-based
5773  *	index of the pattern that caused the wakeup, in the patterns passed
5774  *	to the kernel when configuring.
5775  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_SUPPORTED: Not a real trigger, and cannot be
5776  *	used when setting, used only to indicate that GTK rekeying is supported
5777  *	by the device (flag)
5778  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE: wake up on GTK rekey failure (if
5779  *	done by the device) (flag)
5780  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_EAP_IDENT_REQUEST: wake up on EAP Identity Request
5781  *	packet (flag)
5782  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_4WAY_HANDSHAKE: wake up on 4-way handshake (flag)
5783  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_RFKILL_RELEASE: wake up when rfkill is released
5784  *	(on devices that have rfkill in the device) (flag)
5785  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211: For wakeup reporting only, contains
5786  *	the 802.11 packet that caused the wakeup, e.g. a deauth frame. The frame
5787  *	may be truncated, the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211_LEN
5788  *	attribute contains the original length.
5789  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211_LEN: Original length of the 802.11
5790  *	packet, may be bigger than the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211
5791  *	attribute if the packet was truncated somewhere.
5792  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023: For wakeup reporting only, contains the
5793  *	802.11 packet that caused the wakeup, e.g. a magic packet. The frame may
5794  *	be truncated, the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023_LEN attribute
5795  *	contains the original length.
5796  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023_LEN: Original length of the 802.3
5797  *	packet, may be bigger than the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023
5798  *	attribute if the packet was truncated somewhere.
5799  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_TCP_CONNECTION: TCP connection wake, see DOC section
5800  *	"TCP connection wakeup" for more details. This is a nested attribute
5801  *	containing the exact information for establishing and keeping alive
5802  *	the TCP connection.
5803  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_MATCH: For wakeup reporting only, the
5804  *	wakeup packet was received on the TCP connection
5805  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_CONNLOST: For wakeup reporting only, the
5806  *	TCP connection was lost or failed to be established
5807  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_NOMORETOKENS: For wakeup reporting only,
5808  *	the TCP connection ran out of tokens to use for data to send to the
5809  *	service
5810  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT: wake up when a configured network
5811  *	is detected.  This is a nested attribute that contains the
5812  *	same attributes used with @NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN.  It
5813  *	specifies how the scan is performed (e.g. the interval, the
5814  *	channels to scan and the initial delay) as well as the scan
5815  *	results that will trigger a wake (i.e. the matchsets).  This
5816  *	attribute is also sent in a response to
5817  *	@NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY, indicating the number of match sets
5818  *	supported by the driver (u32).
5819  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT_RESULTS: nested attribute
5820  *	containing an array with information about what triggered the
5821  *	wake up.  If no elements are present in the array, it means
5822  *	that the information is not available.  If more than one
5823  *	element is present, it means that more than one match
5824  *	occurred.
5825  *	Each element in the array is a nested attribute that contains
5826  *	one optional %NL80211_ATTR_SSID attribute and one optional
5827  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES attribute.  At least one of
5828  *	these attributes must be present.  If
5829  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES contains more than one
5830  *	frequency, it means that the match occurred in more than one
5831  *	channel.
5832  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_UNPROTECTED_DEAUTH_DISASSOC: For wakeup reporting only.
5833  *	Wake up happened due to unprotected deauth or disassoc frame in MFP.
5834  * @NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG: number of wake on wireless triggers
5835  * @MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG: highest wowlan trigger attribute number
5836  *
5837  * These nested attributes are used to configure the wakeup triggers and
5838  * to report the wakeup reason(s).
5839  */
5840 enum nl80211_wowlan_triggers {
5841 	__NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_INVALID,
5842 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_ANY,
5843 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_DISCONNECT,
5844 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_MAGIC_PKT,
5845 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_PKT_PATTERN,
5846 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_SUPPORTED,
5847 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE,
5848 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_EAP_IDENT_REQUEST,
5849 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_4WAY_HANDSHAKE,
5850 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_RFKILL_RELEASE,
5851 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211,
5852 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211_LEN,
5853 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023,
5854 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023_LEN,
5855 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_TCP_CONNECTION,
5856 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_MATCH,
5857 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_CONNLOST,
5858 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_NOMORETOKENS,
5859 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT,
5860 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT_RESULTS,
5861 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_UNPROTECTED_DEAUTH_DISASSOC,
5862 
5863 	/* keep last */
5864 	NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG,
5865 	MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG = NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG - 1
5866 };
5867 
5868 /**
5869  * DOC: TCP connection wakeup
5870  *
5871  * Some devices can establish a TCP connection in order to be woken up by a
5872  * packet coming in from outside their network segment, or behind NAT. If
5873  * configured, the device will establish a TCP connection to the given
5874  * service, and periodically send data to that service. The first data
5875  * packet is usually transmitted after SYN/ACK, also ACKing the SYN/ACK.
5876  * The data packets can optionally include a (little endian) sequence
5877  * number (in the TCP payload!) that is generated by the device, and, also
5878  * optionally, a token from a list of tokens. This serves as a keep-alive
5879  * with the service, and for NATed connections, etc.
5880  *
5881  * During this keep-alive period, the server doesn't send any data to the
5882  * client. When receiving data, it is compared against the wakeup pattern
5883  * (and mask) and if it matches, the host is woken up. Similarly, if the
5884  * connection breaks or cannot be established to start with, the host is
5885  * also woken up.
5886  *
5887  * Developer's note: ARP offload is required for this, otherwise TCP
5888  * response packets might not go through correctly.
5889  */
5890 
5891 /**
5892  * struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq - WoWLAN TCP data sequence
5893  * @start: starting value
5894  * @offset: offset of sequence number in packet
5895  * @len: length of the sequence value to write, 1 through 4
5896  *
5897  * Note: don't confuse with the TCP sequence number(s), this is for the
5898  * keepalive packet payload. The actual value is written into the packet
5899  * in little endian.
5900  */
5901 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq {
5902 	__u32 start, offset, len;
5903 };
5904 
5905 /**
5906  * struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token - WoWLAN TCP data token config
5907  * @offset: offset of token in packet
5908  * @len: length of each token
5909  * @token_stream: stream of data to be used for the tokens, the length must
5910  *	be a multiple of @len for this to make sense
5911  */
5912 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token {
5913 	__u32 offset, len;
5914 	__u8 token_stream[];
5915 };
5916 
5917 /**
5918  * struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature - data token features
5919  * @min_len: minimum token length
5920  * @max_len: maximum token length
5921  * @bufsize: total available token buffer size (max size of @token_stream)
5922  */
5923 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature {
5924 	__u32 min_len, max_len, bufsize;
5925 };
5926 
5927 /**
5928  * enum nl80211_wowlan_tcp_attrs - WoWLAN TCP connection parameters
5929  * @__NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes
5930  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_IPV4: source IPv4 address (in network byte order)
5931  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_IPV4: destination IPv4 address
5932  *	(in network byte order)
5933  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_MAC: destination MAC address, this is given because
5934  *	route lookup when configured might be invalid by the time we suspend,
5935  *	and doing a route lookup when suspending is no longer possible as it
5936  *	might require ARP querying.
5937  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_PORT: source port (u16); optional, if not given a
5938  *	socket and port will be allocated
5939  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_PORT: destination port (u16)
5940  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD: data packet payload, at least one byte.
5941  *	For feature advertising, a u32 attribute holding the maximum length
5942  *	of the data payload.
5943  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_SEQ: data packet sequence configuration
5944  *	(if desired), a &struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq. For feature
5945  *	advertising it is just a flag
5946  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_TOKEN: data packet token configuration,
5947  *	see &struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token and for advertising see
5948  *	&struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature.
5949  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_INTERVAL: data interval in seconds, maximum
5950  *	interval in feature advertising (u32)
5951  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_PAYLOAD: wake packet payload, for advertising a
5952  *	u32 attribute holding the maximum length
5953  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_MASK: Wake packet payload mask, not used for
5954  *	feature advertising. The mask works like @NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK
5955  *	but on the TCP payload only.
5956  * @NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP: number of TCP attributes
5957  * @MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP: highest attribute number
5958  */
5959 enum nl80211_wowlan_tcp_attrs {
5960 	__NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_INVALID,
5961 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_IPV4,
5962 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_IPV4,
5963 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_MAC,
5964 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_PORT,
5965 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_PORT,
5966 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD,
5967 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_SEQ,
5968 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_TOKEN,
5969 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_INTERVAL,
5970 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_PAYLOAD,
5971 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_MASK,
5972 
5973 	/* keep last */
5974 	NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP,
5975 	MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP = NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP - 1
5976 };
5977 
5978 /**
5979  * struct nl80211_coalesce_rule_support - coalesce rule support information
5980  * @max_rules: maximum number of rules supported
5981  * @pat: packet pattern support information
5982  * @max_delay: maximum supported coalescing delay in msecs
5983  *
5984  * This struct is carried in %NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE in the
5985  * capability information given by the kernel to userspace.
5986  */
5987 struct nl80211_coalesce_rule_support {
5988 	__u32 max_rules;
5989 	struct nl80211_pattern_support pat;
5990 	__u32 max_delay;
5991 } __attribute__((packed));
5992 
5993 /**
5994  * enum nl80211_attr_coalesce_rule - coalesce rule attribute
5995  * @__NL80211_COALESCE_RULE_INVALID: invalid number for nested attribute
5996  * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_DELAY: delay in msecs used for packet coalescing
5997  * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_CONDITION: condition for packet coalescence,
5998  *	see &enum nl80211_coalesce_condition.
5999  * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_PKT_PATTERN: packet offset, pattern is matched
6000  *	after these fixed number of bytes of received packet
6001  * @NUM_NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE: number of attributes
6002  * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_MAX: max attribute number
6003  */
6004 enum nl80211_attr_coalesce_rule {
6005 	__NL80211_COALESCE_RULE_INVALID,
6006 	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_DELAY,
6007 	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_CONDITION,
6008 	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_PKT_PATTERN,
6009 
6010 	/* keep last */
6011 	NUM_NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE,
6012 	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_MAX = NUM_NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE - 1
6013 };
6014 
6015 /**
6016  * enum nl80211_coalesce_condition - coalesce rule conditions
6017  * @NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_MATCH: coalesce Rx packets when patterns
6018  *	in a rule are matched.
6019  * @NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_NO_MATCH: coalesce Rx packets when patterns
6020  *	in a rule are not matched.
6021  */
6022 enum nl80211_coalesce_condition {
6023 	NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_MATCH,
6024 	NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_NO_MATCH
6025 };
6026 
6027 /**
6028  * enum nl80211_iface_limit_attrs - limit attributes
6029  * @NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_UNSPEC: (reserved)
6030  * @NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_MAX: maximum number of interfaces that
6031  *	can be chosen from this set of interface types (u32)
6032  * @NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_TYPES: nested attribute containing a
6033  *	flag attribute for each interface type in this set
6034  * @NUM_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT: number of attributes
6035  * @MAX_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT: highest attribute number
6036  */
6037 enum nl80211_iface_limit_attrs {
6038 	NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_UNSPEC,
6039 	NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_MAX,
6040 	NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_TYPES,
6041 
6042 	/* keep last */
6043 	NUM_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT,
6044 	MAX_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT = NUM_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT - 1
6045 };
6046 
6047 /**
6048  * enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs -- interface combination attributes
6049  *
6050  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_UNSPEC: (reserved)
6051  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_LIMITS: Nested attributes containing the limits
6052  *	for given interface types, see &enum nl80211_iface_limit_attrs.
6053  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_MAXNUM: u32 attribute giving the total number of
6054  *	interfaces that can be created in this group. This number doesn't
6055  *	apply to interfaces purely managed in software, which are listed
6056  *	in a separate attribute %NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACES_SOFTWARE.
6057  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_STA_AP_BI_MATCH: flag attribute specifying that
6058  *	beacon intervals within this group must be all the same even for
6059  *	infrastructure and AP/GO combinations, i.e. the GO(s) must adopt
6060  *	the infrastructure network's beacon interval.
6061  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_NUM_CHANNELS: u32 attribute specifying how many
6062  *	different channels may be used within this group.
6063  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_WIDTHS: u32 attribute containing the bitmap
6064  *	of supported channel widths for radar detection.
6065  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_REGIONS: u32 attribute containing the bitmap
6066  *	of supported regulatory regions for radar detection.
6067  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_BI_MIN_GCD: u32 attribute specifying the minimum GCD of
6068  *	different beacon intervals supported by all the interface combinations
6069  *	in this group (if not present, all beacon intervals be identical).
6070  * @NUM_NL80211_IFACE_COMB: number of attributes
6071  * @MAX_NL80211_IFACE_COMB: highest attribute number
6072  *
6073  * Examples:
6074  *	limits = [ #{STA} <= 1, #{AP} <= 1 ], matching BI, channels = 1, max = 2
6075  *	=> allows an AP and a STA that must match BIs
6076  *
6077  *	numbers = [ #{AP, P2P-GO} <= 8 ], BI min gcd, channels = 1, max = 8,
6078  *	=> allows 8 of AP/GO that can have BI gcd >= min gcd
6079  *
6080  *	numbers = [ #{STA} <= 2 ], channels = 2, max = 2
6081  *	=> allows two STAs on the same or on different channels
6082  *
6083  *	numbers = [ #{STA} <= 1, #{P2P-client,P2P-GO} <= 3 ], max = 4
6084  *	=> allows a STA plus three P2P interfaces
6085  *
6086  * The list of these four possibilities could completely be contained
6087  * within the %NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS attribute to indicate
6088  * that any of these groups must match.
6089  *
6090  * "Combinations" of just a single interface will not be listed here,
6091  * a single interface of any valid interface type is assumed to always
6092  * be possible by itself. This means that implicitly, for each valid
6093  * interface type, the following group always exists:
6094  *	numbers = [ #{<type>} <= 1 ], channels = 1, max = 1
6095  */
6096 enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs {
6097 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_UNSPEC,
6098 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_LIMITS,
6099 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_MAXNUM,
6100 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_STA_AP_BI_MATCH,
6101 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_NUM_CHANNELS,
6102 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_WIDTHS,
6103 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_REGIONS,
6104 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_BI_MIN_GCD,
6105 
6106 	/* keep last */
6107 	NUM_NL80211_IFACE_COMB,
6108 	MAX_NL80211_IFACE_COMB = NUM_NL80211_IFACE_COMB - 1
6109 };
6110 
6111 
6112 /**
6113  * enum nl80211_plink_state - state of a mesh peer link finite state machine
6114  *
6115  * @NL80211_PLINK_LISTEN: initial state, considered the implicit
6116  *	state of non-existent mesh peer links
6117  * @NL80211_PLINK_OPN_SNT: mesh plink open frame has been sent to
6118  *	this mesh peer
6119  * @NL80211_PLINK_OPN_RCVD: mesh plink open frame has been received
6120  *	from this mesh peer
6121  * @NL80211_PLINK_CNF_RCVD: mesh plink confirm frame has been
6122  *	received from this mesh peer
6123  * @NL80211_PLINK_ESTAB: mesh peer link is established
6124  * @NL80211_PLINK_HOLDING: mesh peer link is being closed or cancelled
6125  * @NL80211_PLINK_BLOCKED: all frames transmitted from this mesh
6126  *	plink are discarded, except for authentication frames
6127  * @NUM_NL80211_PLINK_STATES: number of peer link states
6128  * @MAX_NL80211_PLINK_STATES: highest numerical value of plink states
6129  */
6130 enum nl80211_plink_state {
6131 	NL80211_PLINK_LISTEN,
6132 	NL80211_PLINK_OPN_SNT,
6133 	NL80211_PLINK_OPN_RCVD,
6134 	NL80211_PLINK_CNF_RCVD,
6135 	NL80211_PLINK_ESTAB,
6136 	NL80211_PLINK_HOLDING,
6137 	NL80211_PLINK_BLOCKED,
6138 
6139 	/* keep last */
6140 	NUM_NL80211_PLINK_STATES,
6141 	MAX_NL80211_PLINK_STATES = NUM_NL80211_PLINK_STATES - 1
6142 };
6143 
6144 /**
6145  * enum nl80211_plink_action - actions to perform in mesh peers
6146  *
6147  * @NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_NO_ACTION: perform no action
6148  * @NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_OPEN: start mesh peer link establishment
6149  * @NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_BLOCK: block traffic from this mesh peer
6150  * @NUM_NL80211_PLINK_ACTIONS: number of possible actions
6151  */
6152 enum nl80211_plink_action {
6153 	NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_NO_ACTION,
6154 	NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_OPEN,
6155 	NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_BLOCK,
6156 
6157 	NUM_NL80211_PLINK_ACTIONS,
6158 };
6159 
6160 
6161 #define NL80211_KCK_LEN			16
6162 #define NL80211_KEK_LEN			16
6163 #define NL80211_KCK_EXT_LEN		24
6164 #define NL80211_KEK_EXT_LEN		32
6165 #define NL80211_KCK_EXT_LEN_32		32
6166 #define NL80211_REPLAY_CTR_LEN		8
6167 
6168 /**
6169  * enum nl80211_rekey_data - attributes for GTK rekey offload
6170  * @__NL80211_REKEY_DATA_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes
6171  * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KEK: key encryption key (binary)
6172  * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KCK: key confirmation key (binary)
6173  * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_REPLAY_CTR: replay counter (binary)
6174  * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_AKM: AKM data (OUI, suite type)
6175  * @NUM_NL80211_REKEY_DATA: number of rekey attributes (internal)
6176  * @MAX_NL80211_REKEY_DATA: highest rekey attribute (internal)
6177  */
6178 enum nl80211_rekey_data {
6179 	__NL80211_REKEY_DATA_INVALID,
6180 	NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KEK,
6181 	NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KCK,
6182 	NL80211_REKEY_DATA_REPLAY_CTR,
6183 	NL80211_REKEY_DATA_AKM,
6184 
6185 	/* keep last */
6186 	NUM_NL80211_REKEY_DATA,
6187 	MAX_NL80211_REKEY_DATA = NUM_NL80211_REKEY_DATA - 1
6188 };
6189 
6190 /**
6191  * enum nl80211_hidden_ssid - values for %NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID
6192  * @NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_NOT_IN_USE: do not hide SSID (i.e., broadcast it in
6193  *	Beacon frames)
6194  * @NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_LEN: hide SSID by using zero-length SSID element
6195  *	in Beacon frames
6196  * @NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_CONTENTS: hide SSID by using correct length of SSID
6197  *	element in Beacon frames but zero out each byte in the SSID
6198  */
6199 enum nl80211_hidden_ssid {
6200 	NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_NOT_IN_USE,
6201 	NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_LEN,
6202 	NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_CONTENTS
6203 };
6204 
6205 /**
6206  * enum nl80211_sta_wme_attr - station WME attributes
6207  * @__NL80211_STA_WME_INVALID: invalid number for nested attribute
6208  * @NL80211_STA_WME_UAPSD_QUEUES: bitmap of uapsd queues. the format
6209  *	is the same as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field.
6210  * @NL80211_STA_WME_MAX_SP: max service period. the format is the same
6211  *	as the MAX_SP field in the QoS info field (but already shifted down).
6212  * @__NL80211_STA_WME_AFTER_LAST: internal
6213  * @NL80211_STA_WME_MAX: highest station WME attribute
6214  */
6215 enum nl80211_sta_wme_attr {
6216 	__NL80211_STA_WME_INVALID,
6217 	NL80211_STA_WME_UAPSD_QUEUES,
6218 	NL80211_STA_WME_MAX_SP,
6219 
6220 	/* keep last */
6221 	__NL80211_STA_WME_AFTER_LAST,
6222 	NL80211_STA_WME_MAX = __NL80211_STA_WME_AFTER_LAST - 1
6223 };
6224 
6225 /**
6226  * enum nl80211_pmksa_candidate_attr - attributes for PMKSA caching candidates
6227  * @__NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes
6228  * @NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INDEX: candidate index (u32; the smaller, the higher
6229  *	priority)
6230  * @NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_BSSID: candidate BSSID (6 octets)
6231  * @NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_PREAUTH: RSN pre-authentication supported (flag)
6232  * @NUM_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: number of PMKSA caching candidate attributes
6233  *	(internal)
6234  * @MAX_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: highest PMKSA caching candidate attribute
6235  *	(internal)
6236  */
6237 enum nl80211_pmksa_candidate_attr {
6238 	__NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INVALID,
6239 	NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INDEX,
6240 	NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_BSSID,
6241 	NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_PREAUTH,
6242 
6243 	/* keep last */
6244 	NUM_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE,
6245 	MAX_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE = NUM_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE - 1
6246 };
6247 
6248 /**
6249  * enum nl80211_tdls_operation - values for %NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION
6250  * @NL80211_TDLS_DISCOVERY_REQ: Send a TDLS discovery request
6251  * @NL80211_TDLS_SETUP: Setup TDLS link
6252  * @NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN: Teardown a TDLS link which is already established
6253  * @NL80211_TDLS_ENABLE_LINK: Enable TDLS link
6254  * @NL80211_TDLS_DISABLE_LINK: Disable TDLS link
6255  */
6256 enum nl80211_tdls_operation {
6257 	NL80211_TDLS_DISCOVERY_REQ,
6258 	NL80211_TDLS_SETUP,
6259 	NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN,
6260 	NL80211_TDLS_ENABLE_LINK,
6261 	NL80211_TDLS_DISABLE_LINK,
6262 };
6263 
6264 /**
6265  * enum nl80211_ap_sme_features - device-integrated AP features
6266  * @NL80211_AP_SME_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD: SA Query procedures offloaded to driver
6267  *	when user space indicates support for SA Query procedures offload during
6268  *	"start ap" with %NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT.
6269  */
6270 enum nl80211_ap_sme_features {
6271 	NL80211_AP_SME_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD		= 1 << 0,
6272 };
6273 
6274 /**
6275  * enum nl80211_feature_flags - device/driver features
6276  * @NL80211_FEATURE_SK_TX_STATUS: This driver supports reflecting back
6277  *	TX status to the socket error queue when requested with the
6278  *	socket option.
6279  * @NL80211_FEATURE_HT_IBSS: This driver supports IBSS with HT datarates.
6280  * @NL80211_FEATURE_INACTIVITY_TIMER: This driver takes care of freeing up
6281  *	the connected inactive stations in AP mode.
6282  * @NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS: This driver has been tested
6283  *	to work properly to support receiving regulatory hints from
6284  *	cellular base stations.
6285  * @NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_DEVICE_NEEDS_CHANNEL: (no longer available, only
6286  *	here to reserve the value for API/ABI compatibility)
6287  * @NL80211_FEATURE_SAE: This driver supports simultaneous authentication of
6288  *	equals (SAE) with user space SME (NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE) in station
6289  *	mode
6290  * @NL80211_FEATURE_LOW_PRIORITY_SCAN: This driver supports low priority scan
6291  * @NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_FLUSH: Scan flush is supported
6292  * @NL80211_FEATURE_AP_SCAN: Support scanning using an AP vif
6293  * @NL80211_FEATURE_VIF_TXPOWER: The driver supports per-vif TX power setting
6294  * @NL80211_FEATURE_NEED_OBSS_SCAN: The driver expects userspace to perform
6295  *	OBSS scans and generate 20/40 BSS coex reports. This flag is used only
6296  *	for drivers implementing the CONNECT API, for AUTH/ASSOC it is implied.
6297  * @NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_CTWIN: P2P GO implementation supports CT Window
6298  *	setting
6299  * @NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_OPPPS: P2P GO implementation supports opportunistic
6300  *	powersave
6301  * @NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE: The driver supports full state
6302  *	transitions for AP clients. Without this flag (and if the driver
6303  *	doesn't have the AP SME in the device) the driver supports adding
6304  *	stations only when they're associated and adds them in associated
6305  *	state (to later be transitioned into authorized), with this flag
6306  *	they should be added before even sending the authentication reply
6307  *	and then transitioned into authenticated, associated and authorized
6308  *	states using station flags.
6309  *	Note that even for drivers that support this, the default is to add
6310  *	stations in authenticated/associated state, so to add unauthenticated
6311  *	stations the authenticated/associated bits have to be set in the mask.
6312  * @NL80211_FEATURE_ADVERTISE_CHAN_LIMITS: cfg80211 advertises channel limits
6313  *	(HT40, VHT 80/160 MHz) if this flag is set
6314  * @NL80211_FEATURE_USERSPACE_MPM: This driver supports a userspace Mesh
6315  *	Peering Management entity which may be implemented by registering for
6316  *	beacons or NL80211_CMD_NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE events. The mesh beacon is
6317  *	still generated by the driver.
6318  * @NL80211_FEATURE_ACTIVE_MONITOR: This driver supports an active monitor
6319  *	interface. An active monitor interface behaves like a normal monitor
6320  *	interface, but gets added to the driver. It ensures that incoming
6321  *	unicast packets directed at the configured interface address get ACKed.
6322  * @NL80211_FEATURE_AP_MODE_CHAN_WIDTH_CHANGE: This driver supports dynamic
6323  *	channel bandwidth change (e.g., HT 20 <-> 40 MHz channel) during the
6324  *	lifetime of a BSS.
6325  * @NL80211_FEATURE_DS_PARAM_SET_IE_IN_PROBES: This device adds a DS Parameter
6326  *	Set IE to probe requests.
6327  * @NL80211_FEATURE_WFA_TPC_IE_IN_PROBES: This device adds a WFA TPC Report IE
6328  *	to probe requests.
6329  * @NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET: This device, in client mode, supports Quiet Period
6330  *	requests sent to it by an AP.
6331  * @NL80211_FEATURE_TX_POWER_INSERTION: This device is capable of inserting the
6332  *	current tx power value into the TPC Report IE in the spectrum
6333  *	management TPC Report action frame, and in the Radio Measurement Link
6334  *	Measurement Report action frame.
6335  * @NL80211_FEATURE_ACKTO_ESTIMATION: This driver supports dynamic ACK timeout
6336  *	estimation (dynack). %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_DYN_ACK flag attribute is used
6337  *	to enable dynack.
6338  * @NL80211_FEATURE_STATIC_SMPS: Device supports static spatial
6339  *	multiplexing powersave, ie. can turn off all but one chain
6340  *	even on HT connections that should be using more chains.
6341  * @NL80211_FEATURE_DYNAMIC_SMPS: Device supports dynamic spatial
6342  *	multiplexing powersave, ie. can turn off all but one chain
6343  *	and then wake the rest up as required after, for example,
6344  *	rts/cts handshake.
6345  * @NL80211_FEATURE_SUPPORTS_WMM_ADMISSION: the device supports setting up WMM
6346  *	TSPEC sessions (TID aka TSID 0-7) with the %NL80211_CMD_ADD_TX_TS
6347  *	command. Standard IEEE 802.11 TSPEC setup is not yet supported, it
6348  *	needs to be able to handle Block-Ack agreements and other things.
6349  * @NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE: Device supports configuring
6350  *	the vif's MAC address upon creation.
6351  *	See 'macaddr' field in the vif_params (cfg80211.h).
6352  * @NL80211_FEATURE_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Driver supports channel switching when
6353  *	operating as a TDLS peer.
6354  * @NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR: This device/driver supports using a
6355  *	random MAC address during scan (if the device is unassociated); the
6356  *	%NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR flag may be set for scans and the MAC
6357  *	address mask/value will be used.
6358  * @NL80211_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR: This device/driver supports
6359  *	using a random MAC address for every scan iteration during scheduled
6360  *	scan (while not associated), the %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR may
6361  *	be set for scheduled scan and the MAC address mask/value will be used.
6362  * @NL80211_FEATURE_ND_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR: This device/driver supports using a
6363  *	random MAC address for every scan iteration during "net detect", i.e.
6364  *	scan in unassociated WoWLAN, the %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR may
6365  *	be set for scheduled scan and the MAC address mask/value will be used.
6366  */
6367 enum nl80211_feature_flags {
6368 	NL80211_FEATURE_SK_TX_STATUS			= 1 << 0,
6369 	NL80211_FEATURE_HT_IBSS				= 1 << 1,
6370 	NL80211_FEATURE_INACTIVITY_TIMER		= 1 << 2,
6371 	NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS		= 1 << 3,
6372 	NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_DEVICE_NEEDS_CHANNEL	= 1 << 4,
6373 	NL80211_FEATURE_SAE				= 1 << 5,
6374 	NL80211_FEATURE_LOW_PRIORITY_SCAN		= 1 << 6,
6375 	NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_FLUSH			= 1 << 7,
6376 	NL80211_FEATURE_AP_SCAN				= 1 << 8,
6377 	NL80211_FEATURE_VIF_TXPOWER			= 1 << 9,
6378 	NL80211_FEATURE_NEED_OBSS_SCAN			= 1 << 10,
6379 	NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_CTWIN			= 1 << 11,
6380 	NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_OPPPS			= 1 << 12,
6381 	/* bit 13 is reserved */
6382 	NL80211_FEATURE_ADVERTISE_CHAN_LIMITS		= 1 << 14,
6383 	NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE		= 1 << 15,
6384 	NL80211_FEATURE_USERSPACE_MPM			= 1 << 16,
6385 	NL80211_FEATURE_ACTIVE_MONITOR			= 1 << 17,
6386 	NL80211_FEATURE_AP_MODE_CHAN_WIDTH_CHANGE	= 1 << 18,
6387 	NL80211_FEATURE_DS_PARAM_SET_IE_IN_PROBES	= 1 << 19,
6388 	NL80211_FEATURE_WFA_TPC_IE_IN_PROBES		= 1 << 20,
6389 	NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET				= 1 << 21,
6390 	NL80211_FEATURE_TX_POWER_INSERTION		= 1 << 22,
6391 	NL80211_FEATURE_ACKTO_ESTIMATION		= 1 << 23,
6392 	NL80211_FEATURE_STATIC_SMPS			= 1 << 24,
6393 	NL80211_FEATURE_DYNAMIC_SMPS			= 1 << 25,
6394 	NL80211_FEATURE_SUPPORTS_WMM_ADMISSION		= 1 << 26,
6395 	NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE			= 1 << 27,
6396 	NL80211_FEATURE_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH		= 1 << 28,
6397 	NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR		= 1 << 29,
6398 	NL80211_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR	= 1 << 30,
6399 	NL80211_FEATURE_ND_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR		= 1U << 31,
6400 };
6401 
6402 /**
6403  * enum nl80211_ext_feature_index - bit index of extended features.
6404  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VHT_IBSS: This driver supports IBSS with VHT datarates.
6405  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RRM: This driver supports RRM. When featured, user can
6406  *	request to use RRM (see %NL80211_ATTR_USE_RRM) with
6407  *	%NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT requests, which will set
6408  *	the ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM flag in the association request even if
6409  *	NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET is not advertised.
6410  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MU_MIMO_AIR_SNIFFER: This device supports MU-MIMO air
6411  *	sniffer which means that it can be configured to hear packets from
6412  *	certain groups which can be configured by the
6413  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_GROUP_DATA attribute,
6414  *	or can be configured to follow a station by configuring the
6415  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_FOLLOW_MAC_ADDR attribute.
6416  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_START_TIME: This driver includes the actual
6417  *	time the scan started in scan results event. The time is the TSF of
6418  *	the BSS that the interface that requested the scan is connected to
6419  *	(if available).
6420  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_PARENT_TSF: Per BSS, this driver reports the
6421  *	time the last beacon/probe was received. For a non-MLO connection, the
6422  *	time is the TSF of the BSS that the interface that requested the scan is
6423  *	connected to (if available). For an MLO connection, the time is the TSF
6424  *	of the BSS corresponding with link ID specified in the scan request (if
6425  *	specified).
6426  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SET_SCAN_DWELL: This driver supports configuration of
6427  *	channel dwell time.
6428  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_LEGACY: Driver supports beacon rate
6429  *	configuration (AP/mesh), supporting a legacy (non-HT/VHT) rate.
6430  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HT: Driver supports beacon rate
6431  *	configuration (AP/mesh) with HT rates.
6432  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_VHT: Driver supports beacon rate
6433  *	configuration (AP/mesh) with VHT rates.
6434  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_STA: This driver supports Fast Initial Link Setup
6435  *	with user space SME (NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE) in station mode.
6436  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA: This driver supports randomized TA
6437  *	in @NL80211_CMD_FRAME while not associated.
6438  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA_CONNECTED: This driver supports
6439  *	randomized TA in @NL80211_CMD_FRAME while associated.
6440  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI: The driver supports sched_scan
6441  *	for reporting BSSs with better RSSI than the current connected BSS
6442  *	(%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI).
6443  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST: With this driver the
6444  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THOLD attribute accepts a list of zero or more
6445  *	RSSI threshold values to monitor rather than exactly one threshold.
6446  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_SK_OFFLOAD: Driver SME supports FILS shared key
6447  *	authentication with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
6448  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_PSK: Device wants to do 4-way
6449  *	handshake with PSK in station mode (PSK is passed as part of the connect
6450  *	and associate commands), doing it in the host might not be supported.
6451  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_1X: Device wants to do doing 4-way
6452  *	handshake with 802.1X in station mode (will pass EAP frames to the host
6453  *	and accept the set_pmk/del_pmk commands), doing it in the host might not
6454  *	be supported.
6455  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME: Driver is capable of overriding
6456  *	the max channel attribute in the FILS request params IE with the
6457  *	actual dwell time.
6458  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Driver accepts broadcast probe
6459  *	response
6460  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE: Driver supports sending
6461  *	the first probe request in each channel at rate of at least 5.5Mbps.
6462  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION: Driver supports
6463  *	probe request tx deferral and suppression
6464  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MFP_OPTIONAL: Driver supports the %NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL
6465  *	value in %NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP.
6466  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_SPAN_SCAN: Driver supports low span scan.
6467  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_POWER_SCAN: Driver supports low power scan.
6468  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_HIGH_ACCURACY_SCAN: Driver supports high accuracy scan.
6469  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_OFFLOAD: HW/driver will offload DFS actions.
6470  *	Device or driver will do all DFS-related actions by itself,
6471  *	informing user-space about CAC progress, radar detection event,
6472  *	channel change triggered by radar detection event.
6473  *	No need to start CAC from user-space, no need to react to
6474  *	"radar detected" event.
6475  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211: Driver supports sending and
6476  *	receiving control port frames over nl80211 instead of the netdevice.
6477  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT: This driver/device supports
6478  *	(average) ACK signal strength reporting.
6479  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DATA_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT: Backward-compatible ID
6480  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_TXQS: Driver supports FQ-CoDel-enabled intermediate
6481  *      TXQs.
6482  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_SN: Driver/device supports randomizing the
6483  *	SN in probe request frames if requested by %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_SN.
6484  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT: Driver/device can omit all data
6485  *	except for supported rates from the probe request content if requested
6486  *	by the %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT flag.
6487  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ENABLE_FTM_RESPONDER: Driver supports enabling fine
6488  *	timing measurement responder role.
6489  *
6490  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0: Driver/device confirm that they are
6491  *      able to rekey an in-use key correctly. Userspace must not rekey PTK keys
6492  *      if this flag is not set. Ignoring this can leak clear text packets and/or
6493  *      freeze the connection.
6494  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_EXT_KEY_ID: Driver supports "Extended Key ID for
6495  *      Individually Addressed Frames" from IEEE802.11-2016.
6496  *
6497  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AIRTIME_FAIRNESS: Driver supports getting airtime
6498  *	fairness for transmitted packets and has enabled airtime fairness
6499  *	scheduling.
6500  *
6501  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AP_PMKSA_CACHING: Driver/device supports PMKSA caching
6502  *	(set/del PMKSA operations) in AP mode.
6503  *
6504  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_BAND_SPECIFIC_RSSI_THOLD: Obsolete
6505  *
6506  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_STA_TX_PWR: This driver supports controlling tx power
6507  *	to a station.
6508  *
6509  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD: Device wants to do SAE authentication in
6510  *	station mode (SAE password is passed as part of the connect command).
6511  *
6512  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VLAN_OFFLOAD: The driver supports a single netdev
6513  *	with VLAN tagged frames and separate VLAN-specific netdevs added using
6514  *	vconfig similarly to the Ethernet case.
6515  *
6516  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AQL: The driver supports the Airtime Queue Limit (AQL)
6517  *	feature, which prevents bufferbloat by using the expected transmission
6518  *	time to limit the amount of data buffered in the hardware.
6519  *
6520  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION: The driver supports Beacon protection
6521  *	and can receive key configuration for BIGTK using key indexes 6 and 7.
6522  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION_CLIENT: The driver supports Beacon
6523  *	protection as a client only and cannot transmit protected beacons.
6524  *
6525  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH: The driver can disable the
6526  *	forwarding of preauth frames over the control port. They are then
6527  *	handled as ordinary data frames.
6528  *
6529  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PROTECTED_TWT: Driver supports protected TWT frames
6530  *
6531  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DEL_IBSS_STA: The driver supports removing stations
6532  *      in IBSS mode, essentially by dropping their state.
6533  *
6534  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MULTICAST_REGISTRATIONS: management frame registrations
6535  *	are possible for multicast frames and those will be reported properly.
6536  *
6537  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ: This driver supports receiving and
6538  *	reporting scan request with %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ. In order to
6539  *	report %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ, %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FREQ_KHZ must be
6540  *	included in the scan request.
6541  *
6542  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211_TX_STATUS: The driver
6543  *	can report tx status for control port over nl80211 tx operations.
6544  *
6545  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OPERATING_CHANNEL_VALIDATION: Driver supports Operating
6546  *	Channel Validation (OCV) when using driver's SME for RSNA handshakes.
6547  *
6548  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_AP_PSK: Device wants to do 4-way
6549  *	handshake with PSK in AP mode (PSK is passed as part of the start AP
6550  *	command).
6551  *
6552  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD_AP: Device wants to do SAE authentication
6553  *	in AP mode (SAE password is passed as part of the start AP command).
6554  *
6555  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_DISCOVERY: Driver/device supports FILS discovery
6556  *	frames transmission
6557  *
6558  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Driver/device supports
6559  *	unsolicited broadcast probe response transmission
6560  *
6561  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HE: Driver supports beacon rate
6562  *	configuration (AP/mesh) with HE rates.
6563  *
6564  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_LTF: Device supports secure LTF measurement
6565  *      exchange protocol.
6566  *
6567  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_RTT: Device supports secure RTT measurement
6568  *      exchange protocol.
6569  *
6570  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PROT_RANGE_NEGO_AND_MEASURE: Device supports management
6571  *      frame protection for all management frames exchanged during the
6572  *      negotiation and range measurement procedure.
6573  *
6574  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_COLOR: The driver supports BSS color collision
6575  *	detection and change announcemnts.
6576  *
6577  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_CRYPTO_OFFLOAD: Driver running in AP mode supports
6578  *	FILS encryption and decryption for (Re)Association Request and Response
6579  *	frames. Userspace has to share FILS AAD details to the driver by using
6580  *	@NL80211_CMD_SET_FILS_AAD.
6581  *
6582  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RADAR_BACKGROUND: Device supports background radar/CAC
6583  *	detection.
6584  *
6585  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_POWERED_ADDR_CHANGE: Device can perform a MAC address
6586  *	change without having to bring the underlying network device down
6587  *	first. For example, in station mode this can be used to vary the
6588  *	origin MAC address prior to a connection to a new AP for privacy
6589  *	or other reasons. Note that certain driver specific restrictions
6590  *	might apply, e.g. no scans in progress, no offchannel operations
6591  *	in progress, and no active connections.
6592  *
6593  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PUNCT: Driver supports preamble puncturing in AP mode.
6594  *
6595  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_NAN: Device supports NAN Pairing which enables
6596  *	authentication, data encryption and message integrity.
6597  *
6598  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AUTH_AND_DEAUTH_RANDOM_TA: Device supports randomized TA
6599  *	in authentication and deauthentication frames sent to unassociated peer
6600  *	using @NL80211_CMD_FRAME.
6601  *
6602  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OWE_OFFLOAD: Driver/Device wants to do OWE DH IE
6603  *	handling in station mode.
6604  *
6605  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OWE_OFFLOAD_AP: Driver/Device wants to do OWE DH IE
6606  *	handling in AP mode.
6607  *
6608  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_CONCURRENT: The device supports peer-to-peer or
6609  *	ad hoc operation on DFS channels under the control of a concurrent
6610  *	DFS master on the same channel as described in FCC-594280 D01
6611  *	(Section B.3). This, for example, allows P2P GO and P2P clients to
6612  *	operate on DFS channels as long as there's a concurrent BSS connection.
6613  *
6614  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SPP_AMSDU_SUPPORT: The driver has support for SPP
6615  *	(signaling and payload protected) A-MSDUs and this shall be advertised
6616  *	in the RSNXE.
6617  *
6618  * @NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES: number of extended features.
6619  * @MAX_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES: highest extended feature index.
6620  */
6621 enum nl80211_ext_feature_index {
6622 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VHT_IBSS,
6623 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RRM,
6624 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MU_MIMO_AIR_SNIFFER,
6625 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_START_TIME,
6626 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_PARENT_TSF,
6627 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SET_SCAN_DWELL,
6628 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_LEGACY,
6629 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HT,
6630 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_VHT,
6631 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_STA,
6632 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA,
6633 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA_CONNECTED,
6634 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI,
6635 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST,
6636 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_SK_OFFLOAD,
6637 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_PSK,
6638 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_1X,
6639 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME,
6640 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP,
6641 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE,
6642 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION,
6643 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MFP_OPTIONAL,
6644 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_SPAN_SCAN,
6645 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_POWER_SCAN,
6646 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_HIGH_ACCURACY_SCAN,
6647 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_OFFLOAD,
6648 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211,
6649 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT,
6650 	/* we renamed this - stay compatible */
6651 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DATA_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT = NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT,
6652 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_TXQS,
6653 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_SN,
6654 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT,
6655 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0,
6656 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ENABLE_FTM_RESPONDER,
6657 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AIRTIME_FAIRNESS,
6658 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AP_PMKSA_CACHING,
6659 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_BAND_SPECIFIC_RSSI_THOLD, /* obsolete */
6660 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_EXT_KEY_ID,
6661 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_STA_TX_PWR,
6662 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD,
6663 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VLAN_OFFLOAD,
6664 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AQL,
6665 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION,
6666 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH,
6667 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PROTECTED_TWT,
6668 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DEL_IBSS_STA,
6669 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MULTICAST_REGISTRATIONS,
6670 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION_CLIENT,
6671 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ,
6672 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211_TX_STATUS,
6673 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OPERATING_CHANNEL_VALIDATION,
6674 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_AP_PSK,
6675 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD_AP,
6676 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_DISCOVERY,
6677 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP,
6678 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HE,
6679 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_LTF,
6680 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_RTT,
6681 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PROT_RANGE_NEGO_AND_MEASURE,
6682 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_COLOR,
6683 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_CRYPTO_OFFLOAD,
6684 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RADAR_BACKGROUND,
6685 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_POWERED_ADDR_CHANGE,
6686 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PUNCT,
6687 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_NAN,
6688 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AUTH_AND_DEAUTH_RANDOM_TA,
6689 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OWE_OFFLOAD,
6690 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OWE_OFFLOAD_AP,
6691 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_CONCURRENT,
6692 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SPP_AMSDU_SUPPORT,
6693 
6694 	/* add new features before the definition below */
6695 	NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES,
6696 	MAX_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES = NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES - 1
6697 };
6698 
6699 /**
6700  * enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr - optional supported
6701  *	protocols for probe-response offloading by the driver/FW.
6702  *	To be used with the %NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD attribute.
6703  *	Each enum value represents a bit in the bitmap of supported
6704  *	protocols. Typically a subset of probe-requests belonging to a
6705  *	supported protocol will be excluded from offload and uploaded
6706  *	to the host.
6707  *
6708  * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS: Support for WPS ver. 1
6709  * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS2: Support for WPS ver. 2
6710  * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_P2P: Support for P2P
6711  * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_80211U: Support for 802.11u
6712  */
6713 enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr {
6714 	NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS =	1<<0,
6715 	NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS2 =	1<<1,
6716 	NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_P2P =	1<<2,
6717 	NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_80211U =	1<<3,
6718 };
6719 
6720 /**
6721  * enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason - connection request failed reasons
6722  * @NL80211_CONN_FAIL_MAX_CLIENTS: Maximum number of clients that can be
6723  *	handled by the AP is reached.
6724  * @NL80211_CONN_FAIL_BLOCKED_CLIENT: Connection request is rejected due to ACL.
6725  */
6726 enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason {
6727 	NL80211_CONN_FAIL_MAX_CLIENTS,
6728 	NL80211_CONN_FAIL_BLOCKED_CLIENT,
6729 };
6730 
6731 /**
6732  * enum nl80211_timeout_reason - timeout reasons
6733  *
6734  * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED: Timeout reason unspecified.
6735  * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_SCAN: Scan (AP discovery) timed out.
6736  * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_AUTH: Authentication timed out.
6737  * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_ASSOC: Association timed out.
6738  */
6739 enum nl80211_timeout_reason {
6740 	NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED,
6741 	NL80211_TIMEOUT_SCAN,
6742 	NL80211_TIMEOUT_AUTH,
6743 	NL80211_TIMEOUT_ASSOC,
6744 };
6745 
6746 /**
6747  * enum nl80211_scan_flags -  scan request control flags
6748  *
6749  * Scan request control flags are used to control the handling
6750  * of NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN and NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN
6751  * requests.
6752  *
6753  * NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_SPAN, NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_POWER, and
6754  * NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_HIGH_ACCURACY flags are exclusive of each other, i.e., only
6755  * one of them can be used in the request.
6756  *
6757  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_PRIORITY: scan request has low priority
6758  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FLUSH: flush cache before scanning
6759  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_AP: force a scan even if the interface is configured
6760  *	as AP and the beaconing has already been configured. This attribute is
6761  *	dangerous because will destroy stations performance as a lot of frames
6762  *	will be lost while scanning off-channel, therefore it must be used only
6763  *	when really needed
6764  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR: use a random MAC address for this scan (or
6765  *	for scheduled scan: a different one for every scan iteration). When the
6766  *	flag is set, depending on device capabilities the @NL80211_ATTR_MAC and
6767  *	@NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK attributes may also be given in which case only
6768  *	the masked bits will be preserved from the MAC address and the remainder
6769  *	randomised. If the attributes are not given full randomisation (46 bits,
6770  *	locally administered 1, multicast 0) is assumed.
6771  *	This flag must not be requested when the feature isn't supported, check
6772  *	the nl80211 feature flags for the device.
6773  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME: fill the dwell time in the FILS
6774  *	request parameters IE in the probe request
6775  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: accept broadcast probe responses
6776  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE: send probe request frames at
6777  *	rate of at least 5.5M. In case non-OCE AP is discovered in the channel,
6778  *	only the first probe req in the channel will be sent in high rate.
6779  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION: allow probe request
6780  *	tx deferral (dot11FILSProbeDelay shall be set to 15ms)
6781  *	and suppression (if it has received a broadcast Probe Response frame,
6782  *	Beacon frame or FILS Discovery frame from an AP that the STA considers
6783  *	a suitable candidate for (re-)association - suitable in terms of
6784  *	SSID and/or RSSI.
6785  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_SPAN: Span corresponds to the total time taken to
6786  *	accomplish the scan. Thus, this flag intends the driver to perform the
6787  *	scan request with lesser span/duration. It is specific to the driver
6788  *	implementations on how this is accomplished. Scan accuracy may get
6789  *	impacted with this flag.
6790  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_POWER: This flag intends the scan attempts to consume
6791  *	optimal possible power. Drivers can resort to their specific means to
6792  *	optimize the power. Scan accuracy may get impacted with this flag.
6793  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_HIGH_ACCURACY: Accuracy here intends to the extent of scan
6794  *	results obtained. Thus HIGH_ACCURACY scan flag aims to get maximum
6795  *	possible scan results. This flag hints the driver to use the best
6796  *	possible scan configuration to improve the accuracy in scanning.
6797  *	Latency and power use may get impacted with this flag.
6798  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_SN: randomize the sequence number in probe
6799  *	request frames from this scan to avoid correlation/tracking being
6800  *	possible.
6801  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT: minimize probe request content to
6802  *	only have supported rates and no additional capabilities (unless
6803  *	added by userspace explicitly.)
6804  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FREQ_KHZ: report scan results with
6805  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ. This also means
6806  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES will not be included.
6807  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_COLOCATED_6GHZ: scan for collocated APs reported by
6808  *	2.4/5 GHz APs. When the flag is set, the scan logic will use the
6809  *	information from the RNR element found in beacons/probe responses
6810  *	received on the 2.4/5 GHz channels to actively scan only the 6GHz
6811  *	channels on which APs are expected to be found. Note that when not set,
6812  *	the scan logic would scan all 6GHz channels, but since transmission of
6813  *	probe requests on non-PSC channels is limited, it is highly likely that
6814  *	these channels would passively be scanned. Also note that when the flag
6815  *	is set, in addition to the colocated APs, PSC channels would also be
6816  *	scanned if the user space has asked for it.
6817  */
6818 enum nl80211_scan_flags {
6819 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_PRIORITY				= 1<<0,
6820 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FLUSH					= 1<<1,
6821 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_AP					= 1<<2,
6822 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR				= 1<<3,
6823 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME			= 1<<4,
6824 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP		= 1<<5,
6825 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE		= 1<<6,
6826 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION	= 1<<7,
6827 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_SPAN				= 1<<8,
6828 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_POWER				= 1<<9,
6829 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_HIGH_ACCURACY				= 1<<10,
6830 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_SN				= 1<<11,
6831 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT			= 1<<12,
6832 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FREQ_KHZ				= 1<<13,
6833 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_COLOCATED_6GHZ			= 1<<14,
6834 };
6835 
6836 /**
6837  * enum nl80211_acl_policy - access control policy
6838  *
6839  * Access control policy is applied on a MAC list set by
6840  * %NL80211_CMD_START_AP and %NL80211_CMD_SET_MAC_ACL, to
6841  * be used with %NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY.
6842  *
6843  * @NL80211_ACL_POLICY_ACCEPT_UNLESS_LISTED: Deny stations which are
6844  *	listed in ACL, i.e. allow all the stations which are not listed
6845  *	in ACL to authenticate.
6846  * @NL80211_ACL_POLICY_DENY_UNLESS_LISTED: Allow the stations which are listed
6847  *	in ACL, i.e. deny all the stations which are not listed in ACL.
6848  */
6849 enum nl80211_acl_policy {
6850 	NL80211_ACL_POLICY_ACCEPT_UNLESS_LISTED,
6851 	NL80211_ACL_POLICY_DENY_UNLESS_LISTED,
6852 };
6853 
6854 /**
6855  * enum nl80211_smps_mode - SMPS mode
6856  *
6857  * Requested SMPS mode (for AP mode)
6858  *
6859  * @NL80211_SMPS_OFF: SMPS off (use all antennas).
6860  * @NL80211_SMPS_STATIC: static SMPS (use a single antenna)
6861  * @NL80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic smps (start with a single antenna and
6862  *	turn on other antennas after CTS/RTS).
6863  * @__NL80211_SMPS_AFTER_LAST: internal
6864  * @NL80211_SMPS_MAX: highest used enumeration
6865  */
6866 enum nl80211_smps_mode {
6867 	NL80211_SMPS_OFF,
6868 	NL80211_SMPS_STATIC,
6869 	NL80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC,
6870 
6871 	__NL80211_SMPS_AFTER_LAST,
6872 	NL80211_SMPS_MAX = __NL80211_SMPS_AFTER_LAST - 1
6873 };
6874 
6875 /**
6876  * enum nl80211_radar_event - type of radar event for DFS operation
6877  *
6878  * Type of event to be used with NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT to inform userspace
6879  * about detected radars or success of the channel available check (CAC)
6880  *
6881  * @NL80211_RADAR_DETECTED: A radar pattern has been detected. The channel is
6882  *	now unusable.
6883  * @NL80211_RADAR_CAC_FINISHED: Channel Availability Check has been finished,
6884  *	the channel is now available.
6885  * @NL80211_RADAR_CAC_ABORTED: Channel Availability Check has been aborted, no
6886  *	change to the channel status.
6887  * @NL80211_RADAR_NOP_FINISHED: The Non-Occupancy Period for this channel is
6888  *	over, channel becomes usable.
6889  * @NL80211_RADAR_PRE_CAC_EXPIRED: Channel Availability Check done on this
6890  *	non-operating channel is expired and no longer valid. New CAC must
6891  *	be done on this channel before starting the operation. This is not
6892  *	applicable for ETSI dfs domain where pre-CAC is valid for ever.
6893  * @NL80211_RADAR_CAC_STARTED: Channel Availability Check has been started,
6894  *	should be generated by HW if NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_OFFLOAD is enabled.
6895  */
6896 enum nl80211_radar_event {
6897 	NL80211_RADAR_DETECTED,
6898 	NL80211_RADAR_CAC_FINISHED,
6899 	NL80211_RADAR_CAC_ABORTED,
6900 	NL80211_RADAR_NOP_FINISHED,
6901 	NL80211_RADAR_PRE_CAC_EXPIRED,
6902 	NL80211_RADAR_CAC_STARTED,
6903 };
6904 
6905 /**
6906  * enum nl80211_dfs_state - DFS states for channels
6907  *
6908  * Channel states used by the DFS code.
6909  *
6910  * @NL80211_DFS_USABLE: The channel can be used, but channel availability
6911  *	check (CAC) must be performed before using it for AP or IBSS.
6912  * @NL80211_DFS_UNAVAILABLE: A radar has been detected on this channel, it
6913  *	is therefore marked as not available.
6914  * @NL80211_DFS_AVAILABLE: The channel has been CAC checked and is available.
6915  */
6916 enum nl80211_dfs_state {
6917 	NL80211_DFS_USABLE,
6918 	NL80211_DFS_UNAVAILABLE,
6919 	NL80211_DFS_AVAILABLE,
6920 };
6921 
6922 /**
6923  * enum nl80211_protocol_features - nl80211 protocol features
6924  * @NL80211_PROTOCOL_FEATURE_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP: nl80211 supports splitting
6925  *	wiphy dumps (if requested by the application with the attribute
6926  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP. Also supported is filtering the
6927  *	wiphy dump by %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY, %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX or
6928  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WDEV.
6929  */
6930 enum nl80211_protocol_features {
6931 	NL80211_PROTOCOL_FEATURE_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP =	1 << 0,
6932 };
6933 
6934 /**
6935  * enum nl80211_crit_proto_id - nl80211 critical protocol identifiers
6936  *
6937  * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_UNSPEC: protocol unspecified.
6938  * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_DHCP: BOOTP or DHCPv6 protocol.
6939  * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_EAPOL: EAPOL protocol.
6940  * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_APIPA: APIPA protocol.
6941  * @NUM_NL80211_CRIT_PROTO: must be kept last.
6942  */
6943 enum nl80211_crit_proto_id {
6944 	NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_UNSPEC,
6945 	NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_DHCP,
6946 	NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_EAPOL,
6947 	NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_APIPA,
6948 	/* add other protocols before this one */
6949 	NUM_NL80211_CRIT_PROTO
6950 };
6951 
6952 /* maximum duration for critical protocol measures */
6953 #define NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_MAX_DURATION		5000 /* msec */
6954 
6955 /**
6956  * enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags - flags for received management frame.
6957  *
6958  * Used by cfg80211_rx_mgmt()
6959  *
6960  * @NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_ANSWERED: frame was answered by device/driver.
6961  * @NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_EXTERNAL_AUTH: Host driver intends to offload
6962  *	the authentication. Exclusively defined for host drivers that
6963  *	advertises the SME functionality but would like the userspace
6964  *	to handle certain authentication algorithms (e.g. SAE).
6965  */
6966 enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags {
6967 	NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_ANSWERED = 1 << 0,
6968 	NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_EXTERNAL_AUTH = 1 << 1,
6969 };
6970 
6971 /*
6972  * If this flag is unset, the lower 24 bits are an OUI, if set
6973  * a Linux nl80211 vendor ID is used (no such IDs are allocated
6974  * yet, so that's not valid so far)
6975  */
6976 #define NL80211_VENDOR_ID_IS_LINUX	0x80000000
6977 
6978 /**
6979  * struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info - vendor command data
6980  * @vendor_id: If the %NL80211_VENDOR_ID_IS_LINUX flag is clear, then the
6981  *	value is a 24-bit OUI; if it is set then a separately allocated ID
6982  *	may be used, but no such IDs are allocated yet. New IDs should be
6983  *	added to this file when needed.
6984  * @subcmd: sub-command ID for the command
6985  */
6986 struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info {
6987 	__u32 vendor_id;
6988 	__u32 subcmd;
6989 };
6990 
6991 /**
6992  * enum nl80211_tdls_peer_capability - TDLS peer flags.
6993  *
6994  * Used by tdls_mgmt() to determine which conditional elements need
6995  * to be added to TDLS Setup frames.
6996  *
6997  * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HT: TDLS peer is HT capable.
6998  * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_VHT: TDLS peer is VHT capable.
6999  * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_WMM: TDLS peer is WMM capable.
7000  * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HE: TDLS peer is HE capable.
7001  */
7002 enum nl80211_tdls_peer_capability {
7003 	NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HT = 1<<0,
7004 	NL80211_TDLS_PEER_VHT = 1<<1,
7005 	NL80211_TDLS_PEER_WMM = 1<<2,
7006 	NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HE = 1<<3,
7007 };
7008 
7009 /**
7010  * enum nl80211_sched_scan_plan - scanning plan for scheduled scan
7011  * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
7012  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL: interval between scan iterations. In
7013  *	seconds (u32).
7014  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS: number of scan iterations in this
7015  *	scan plan (u32). The last scan plan must not specify this attribute
7016  *	because it will run infinitely. A value of zero is invalid as it will
7017  *	make the scan plan meaningless.
7018  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_MAX: highest scheduled scan plan attribute number
7019  *	currently defined
7020  * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_AFTER_LAST: internal use
7021  */
7022 enum nl80211_sched_scan_plan {
7023 	__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INVALID,
7024 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL,
7025 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS,
7026 
7027 	/* keep last */
7028 	__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_AFTER_LAST,
7029 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_MAX =
7030 		__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_AFTER_LAST - 1
7031 };
7032 
7033 /**
7034  * struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust - RSSI adjustment parameters.
7035  *
7036  * @band: band of BSS that must match for RSSI value adjustment. The value
7037  *	of this field is according to &enum nl80211_band.
7038  * @delta: value used to adjust the RSSI value of matching BSS in dB.
7039  */
7040 struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust {
7041 	__u8 band;
7042 	__s8 delta;
7043 } __attribute__((packed));
7044 
7045 /**
7046  * enum nl80211_bss_select_attr - attributes for bss selection.
7047  *
7048  * @__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_INVALID: reserved.
7049  * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI: Flag indicating only RSSI-based BSS selection
7050  *	is requested.
7051  * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF: attribute indicating BSS
7052  *	selection should be done such that the specified band is preferred.
7053  *	When there are multiple BSS-es in the preferred band, the driver
7054  *	shall use RSSI-based BSS selection as a second step. The value of
7055  *	this attribute is according to &enum nl80211_band (u32).
7056  * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST: When present the RSSI level for
7057  *	BSS-es in the specified band is to be adjusted before doing
7058  *	RSSI-based BSS selection. The attribute value is a packed structure
7059  *	value as specified by &struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust.
7060  * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_MAX: highest bss select attribute number.
7061  * @__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use.
7062  *
7063  * One and only one of these attributes are found within %NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SELECT
7064  * for %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT. It specifies the required BSS selection behaviour
7065  * which the driver shall use.
7066  */
7067 enum nl80211_bss_select_attr {
7068 	__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_INVALID,
7069 	NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI,
7070 	NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF,
7071 	NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST,
7072 
7073 	/* keep last */
7074 	__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
7075 	NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
7076 };
7077 
7078 /**
7079  * enum nl80211_nan_function_type - NAN function type
7080  *
7081  * Defines the function type of a NAN function
7082  *
7083  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH: function is publish
7084  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE: function is subscribe
7085  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP: function is follow-up
7086  * @__NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE_AFTER_LAST: internal use
7087  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_MAX_TYPE: internal use
7088  */
7089 enum nl80211_nan_function_type {
7090 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH,
7091 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE,
7092 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP,
7093 
7094 	/* keep last */
7095 	__NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE_AFTER_LAST,
7096 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_MAX_TYPE = __NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE_AFTER_LAST - 1,
7097 };
7098 
7099 /**
7100  * enum nl80211_nan_publish_type - NAN publish tx type
7101  *
7102  * Defines how to send publish Service Discovery Frames
7103  *
7104  * @NL80211_NAN_SOLICITED_PUBLISH: publish function is solicited
7105  * @NL80211_NAN_UNSOLICITED_PUBLISH: publish function is unsolicited
7106  */
7107 enum nl80211_nan_publish_type {
7108 	NL80211_NAN_SOLICITED_PUBLISH = 1 << 0,
7109 	NL80211_NAN_UNSOLICITED_PUBLISH = 1 << 1,
7110 };
7111 
7112 /**
7113  * enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason - NAN functions termination reason
7114  *
7115  * Defines termination reasons of a NAN function
7116  *
7117  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST: requested by user
7118  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_TTL_EXPIRED: timeout
7119  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_ERROR: errored
7120  */
7121 enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason {
7122 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST,
7123 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_TTL_EXPIRED,
7124 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_ERROR,
7125 };
7126 
7127 #define NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID_LEN 6
7128 #define NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_SPEC_INFO_MAX_LEN 0xff
7129 #define NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SRF_MAX_LEN 0xff
7130 
7131 /**
7132  * enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes - NAN function attributes
7133  * @__NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INVALID: invalid
7134  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE: &enum nl80211_nan_function_type (u8).
7135  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID: 6 bytes of the service ID hash as
7136  *	specified in NAN spec. This is a binary attribute.
7137  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_TYPE: relevant if the function's type is
7138  *	publish. Defines the transmission type for the publish Service Discovery
7139  *	Frame, see &enum nl80211_nan_publish_type. Its type is u8.
7140  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_BCAST: relevant if the function is a solicited
7141  *	publish. Should the solicited publish Service Discovery Frame be sent to
7142  *	the NAN Broadcast address. This is a flag.
7143  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE_ACTIVE: relevant if the function's type is
7144  *	subscribe. Is the subscribe active. This is a flag.
7145  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_ID: relevant if the function's type is follow up.
7146  *	The instance ID for the follow up Service Discovery Frame. This is u8.
7147  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_REQ_ID: relevant if the function's type
7148  *	is follow up. This is a u8.
7149  *	The requester instance ID for the follow up Service Discovery Frame.
7150  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_DEST: the MAC address of the recipient of the
7151  *	follow up Service Discovery Frame. This is a binary attribute.
7152  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_CLOSE_RANGE: is this function limited for devices in a
7153  *	close range. The range itself (RSSI) is defined by the device.
7154  *	This is a flag.
7155  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TTL: strictly positive number of DWs this function should
7156  *	stay active. If not present infinite TTL is assumed. This is a u32.
7157  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_INFO: array of bytes describing the service
7158  *	specific info. This is a binary attribute.
7159  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SRF: Service Receive Filter. This is a nested attribute.
7160  *	See &enum nl80211_nan_srf_attributes.
7161  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_RX_MATCH_FILTER: Receive Matching filter. This is a nested
7162  *	attribute. It is a list of binary values.
7163  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TX_MATCH_FILTER: Transmit Matching filter. This is a
7164  *	nested attribute. It is a list of binary values.
7165  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INSTANCE_ID: The instance ID of the function.
7166  *	Its type is u8 and it cannot be 0.
7167  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON: NAN function termination reason.
7168  *	See &enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason.
7169  *
7170  * @NUM_NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR: internal
7171  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR_MAX: highest NAN function attribute
7172  */
7173 enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes {
7174 	__NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INVALID,
7175 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE,
7176 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID,
7177 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_TYPE,
7178 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_BCAST,
7179 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE_ACTIVE,
7180 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_ID,
7181 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_REQ_ID,
7182 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_DEST,
7183 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_CLOSE_RANGE,
7184 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TTL,
7185 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_INFO,
7186 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SRF,
7187 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_RX_MATCH_FILTER,
7188 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TX_MATCH_FILTER,
7189 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INSTANCE_ID,
7190 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON,
7191 
7192 	/* keep last */
7193 	NUM_NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR,
7194 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR - 1
7195 };
7196 
7197 /**
7198  * enum nl80211_nan_srf_attributes - NAN Service Response filter attributes
7199  * @__NL80211_NAN_SRF_INVALID: invalid
7200  * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_INCLUDE: present if the include bit of the SRF set.
7201  *	This is a flag.
7202  * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF: Bloom Filter. Present if and only if
7203  *	%NL80211_NAN_SRF_MAC_ADDRS isn't present. This attribute is binary.
7204  * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF_IDX: index of the Bloom Filter. Mandatory if
7205  *	%NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF is present. This is a u8.
7206  * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_MAC_ADDRS: list of MAC addresses for the SRF. Present if
7207  *	and only if %NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF isn't present. This is a nested
7208  *	attribute. Each nested attribute is a MAC address.
7209  * @NUM_NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR: internal
7210  * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR_MAX: highest NAN SRF attribute
7211  */
7212 enum nl80211_nan_srf_attributes {
7213 	__NL80211_NAN_SRF_INVALID,
7214 	NL80211_NAN_SRF_INCLUDE,
7215 	NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF,
7216 	NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF_IDX,
7217 	NL80211_NAN_SRF_MAC_ADDRS,
7218 
7219 	/* keep last */
7220 	NUM_NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR,
7221 	NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR - 1,
7222 };
7223 
7224 /**
7225  * enum nl80211_nan_match_attributes - NAN match attributes
7226  * @__NL80211_NAN_MATCH_INVALID: invalid
7227  * @NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_LOCAL: the local function that had the
7228  *	match. This is a nested attribute.
7229  *	See &enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes.
7230  * @NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_PEER: the peer function
7231  *	that caused the match. This is a nested attribute.
7232  *	See &enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes.
7233  *
7234  * @NUM_NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR: internal
7235  * @NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX: highest NAN match attribute
7236  */
7237 enum nl80211_nan_match_attributes {
7238 	__NL80211_NAN_MATCH_INVALID,
7239 	NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_LOCAL,
7240 	NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_PEER,
7241 
7242 	/* keep last */
7243 	NUM_NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR,
7244 	NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR - 1
7245 };
7246 
7247 /**
7248  * enum nl80211_external_auth_action - Action to perform with external
7249  *     authentication request. Used by NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ACTION.
7250  * @NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_START: Start the authentication.
7251  * @NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ABORT: Abort the ongoing authentication.
7252  */
7253 enum nl80211_external_auth_action {
7254 	NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_START,
7255 	NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ABORT,
7256 };
7257 
7258 /**
7259  * enum nl80211_ftm_responder_attributes - fine timing measurement
7260  *	responder attributes
7261  * @__NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7262  * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_ENABLED: FTM responder is enabled
7263  * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI: The content of Measurement Report Element
7264  *	(9.4.2.22 in 802.11-2016) with type 8 - LCI (9.4.2.22.10),
7265  *	i.e. starting with the measurement token
7266  * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVICLOC: The content of Measurement Report Element
7267  *	(9.4.2.22 in 802.11-2016) with type 11 - Civic (Section 9.4.2.22.13),
7268  *	i.e. starting with the measurement token
7269  * @__NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7270  * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest FTM responder attribute.
7271  */
7272 enum nl80211_ftm_responder_attributes {
7273 	__NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID,
7274 
7275 	NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_ENABLED,
7276 	NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI,
7277 	NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVICLOC,
7278 
7279 	/* keep last */
7280 	__NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LAST,
7281 	NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LAST - 1,
7282 };
7283 
7284 /*
7285  * enum nl80211_ftm_responder_stats - FTM responder statistics
7286  *
7287  * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS
7288  * when getting FTM responder statistics.
7289  *
7290  * @__NL80211_FTM_STATS_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
7291  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_SUCCESS_NUM: number of FTM sessions in which all frames
7292  *	were ssfully answered (u32)
7293  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_PARTIAL_NUM: number of FTM sessions in which part of the
7294  *	frames were successfully answered (u32)
7295  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_FAILED_NUM: number of failed FTM sessions (u32)
7296  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_ASAP_NUM: number of ASAP sessions (u32)
7297  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_NON_ASAP_NUM: number of non-ASAP sessions (u32)
7298  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_TOTAL_DURATION_MSEC: total sessions durations - gives an
7299  *	indication of how much time the responder was busy (u64, msec)
7300  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_UNKNOWN_TRIGGERS_NUM: number of unknown FTM triggers -
7301  *	triggers from initiators that didn't finish successfully the negotiation
7302  *	phase with the responder (u32)
7303  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_RESCHEDULE_REQUESTS_NUM: number of FTM reschedule requests
7304  *	- initiator asks for a new scheduling although it already has scheduled
7305  *	FTM slot (u32)
7306  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_OUT_OF_WINDOW_TRIGGERS_NUM: number of FTM triggers out of
7307  *	scheduled window (u32)
7308  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_PAD: used for padding, ignore
7309  * @__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: Internal
7310  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_MAX: highest possible FTM responder stats attribute
7311  */
7312 enum nl80211_ftm_responder_stats {
7313 	__NL80211_FTM_STATS_INVALID,
7314 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_SUCCESS_NUM,
7315 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_PARTIAL_NUM,
7316 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_FAILED_NUM,
7317 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_ASAP_NUM,
7318 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_NON_ASAP_NUM,
7319 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_TOTAL_DURATION_MSEC,
7320 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_UNKNOWN_TRIGGERS_NUM,
7321 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_RESCHEDULE_REQUESTS_NUM,
7322 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_OUT_OF_WINDOW_TRIGGERS_NUM,
7323 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_PAD,
7324 
7325 	/* keep last */
7326 	__NL80211_FTM_STATS_AFTER_LAST,
7327 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_MAX = __NL80211_FTM_STATS_AFTER_LAST - 1
7328 };
7329 
7330 /**
7331  * enum nl80211_preamble - frame preamble types
7332  * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_LEGACY: legacy (HR/DSSS, OFDM, ERP PHY) preamble
7333  * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_HT: HT preamble
7334  * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_VHT: VHT preamble
7335  * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_DMG: DMG preamble
7336  * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_HE: HE preamble
7337  */
7338 enum nl80211_preamble {
7339 	NL80211_PREAMBLE_LEGACY,
7340 	NL80211_PREAMBLE_HT,
7341 	NL80211_PREAMBLE_VHT,
7342 	NL80211_PREAMBLE_DMG,
7343 	NL80211_PREAMBLE_HE,
7344 };
7345 
7346 /**
7347  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type - peer measurement types
7348  * @NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_INVALID: invalid/unused, needed as we use
7349  *	these numbers also for attributes
7350  *
7351  * @NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_FTM: flight time measurement
7352  *
7353  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_TYPES: internal
7354  * @NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_MAX: highest type number
7355  */
7356 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type {
7357 	NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_INVALID,
7358 
7359 	NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_FTM,
7360 
7361 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_TYPES,
7362 	NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_TYPES - 1
7363 };
7364 
7365 /**
7366  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status - peer measurement status
7367  * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_SUCCESS: measurement completed successfully
7368  * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_REFUSED: measurement was locally refused
7369  * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_TIMEOUT: measurement timed out
7370  * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE: measurement failed, a type-dependent
7371  *	reason may be available in the response data
7372  */
7373 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status {
7374 	NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_SUCCESS,
7375 	NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_REFUSED,
7376 	NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_TIMEOUT,
7377 	NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE,
7378 };
7379 
7380 /**
7381  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_req - peer measurement request attributes
7382  * @__NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7383  *
7384  * @NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_DATA: This is a nested attribute with measurement
7385  *	type-specific request data inside. The attributes used are from the
7386  *	enums named nl80211_peer_measurement_<type>_req.
7387  * @NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_GET_AP_TSF: include AP TSF timestamp, if supported
7388  *	(flag attribute)
7389  *
7390  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTRS: internal
7391  * @NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7392  */
7393 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_req {
7394 	__NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_INVALID,
7395 
7396 	NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_DATA,
7397 	NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_GET_AP_TSF,
7398 
7399 	/* keep last */
7400 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTRS,
7401 	NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTRS - 1
7402 };
7403 
7404 /**
7405  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_resp - peer measurement response attributes
7406  * @__NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7407  *
7408  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_DATA: This is a nested attribute with measurement
7409  *	type-specific results inside. The attributes used are from the enums
7410  *	named nl80211_peer_measurement_<type>_resp.
7411  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_STATUS: u32 value with the measurement status
7412  *	(using values from &enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status.)
7413  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_HOST_TIME: host time (%CLOCK_BOOTTIME) when the
7414  *	result was measured; this value is not expected to be accurate to
7415  *	more than 20ms. (u64, nanoseconds)
7416  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_AP_TSF: TSF of the AP that the interface
7417  *	doing the measurement is connected to when the result was measured.
7418  *	This shall be accurately reported if supported and requested
7419  *	(u64, usec)
7420  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_FINAL: If results are sent to the host partially
7421  *	(*e.g. with FTM per-burst data) this flag will be cleared on all but
7422  *	the last result; if all results are combined it's set on the single
7423  *	result.
7424  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_PAD: padding for 64-bit attributes, ignore
7425  *
7426  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTRS: internal
7427  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7428  */
7429 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_resp {
7430 	__NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_INVALID,
7431 
7432 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_DATA,
7433 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_STATUS,
7434 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_HOST_TIME,
7435 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_AP_TSF,
7436 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_FINAL,
7437 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_PAD,
7438 
7439 	/* keep last */
7440 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTRS,
7441 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTRS - 1
7442 };
7443 
7444 /**
7445  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_peer_attrs - peer attributes for measurement
7446  * @__NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7447  *
7448  * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_ADDR: peer's MAC address
7449  * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_CHAN: channel definition, nested, using top-level
7450  *	attributes like %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ etc.
7451  * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_REQ: This is a nested attribute indexed by
7452  *	measurement type, with attributes from the
7453  *	&enum nl80211_peer_measurement_req inside.
7454  * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_RESP: This is a nested attribute indexed by
7455  *	measurement type, with attributes from the
7456  *	&enum nl80211_peer_measurement_resp inside.
7457  *
7458  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTRS: internal
7459  * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7460  */
7461 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_peer_attrs {
7462 	__NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_INVALID,
7463 
7464 	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_ADDR,
7465 	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_CHAN,
7466 	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_REQ,
7467 	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_RESP,
7468 
7469 	/* keep last */
7470 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTRS,
7471 	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTRS - 1,
7472 };
7473 
7474 /**
7475  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_attrs - peer measurement attributes
7476  * @__NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7477  *
7478  * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX_PEERS: u32 attribute used for capability
7479  *	advertisement only, indicates the maximum number of peers
7480  *	measurements can be done with in a single request
7481  * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_REPORT_AP_TSF: flag attribute in capability
7482  *	indicating that the connected AP's TSF can be reported in
7483  *	measurement results
7484  * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_RANDOMIZE_MAC_ADDR: flag attribute in capability
7485  *	indicating that MAC address randomization is supported.
7486  * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_TYPE_CAPA: capabilities reported by the device,
7487  *	this contains a nesting indexed by measurement type, and
7488  *	type-specific capabilities inside, which are from the enums
7489  *	named nl80211_peer_measurement_<type>_capa.
7490  * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_PEERS: nested attribute, the nesting index is
7491  *	meaningless, just a list of peers to measure with, with the
7492  *	sub-attributes taken from
7493  *	&enum nl80211_peer_measurement_peer_attrs.
7494  *
7495  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_ATTR: internal
7496  * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7497  */
7498 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_attrs {
7499 	__NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_INVALID,
7500 
7501 	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX_PEERS,
7502 	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_REPORT_AP_TSF,
7503 	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_RANDOMIZE_MAC_ADDR,
7504 	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_TYPE_CAPA,
7505 	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_PEERS,
7506 
7507 	/* keep last */
7508 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_ATTR,
7509 	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_ATTR - 1
7510 };
7511 
7512 /**
7513  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_capa - FTM capabilities
7514  * @__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7515  *
7516  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_ASAP: flag attribute indicating ASAP mode
7517  *	is supported
7518  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_ASAP: flag attribute indicating non-ASAP
7519  *	mode is supported
7520  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_LCI: flag attribute indicating if LCI
7521  *	data can be requested during the measurement
7522  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_CIVICLOC: flag attribute indicating if civic
7523  *	location data can be requested during the measurement
7524  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_PREAMBLES: u32 bitmap attribute of bits
7525  *	from &enum nl80211_preamble.
7526  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_BANDWIDTHS: bitmap of values from
7527  *	&enum nl80211_chan_width indicating the supported channel
7528  *	bandwidths for FTM. Note that a higher channel bandwidth may be
7529  *	configured to allow for other measurements types with different
7530  *	bandwidth requirement in the same measurement.
7531  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_BURSTS_EXPONENT: u32 attribute indicating
7532  *	the maximum bursts exponent that can be used (if not present anything
7533  *	is valid)
7534  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_FTMS_PER_BURST: u32 attribute indicating
7535  *	the maximum FTMs per burst (if not present anything is valid)
7536  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED: flag attribute indicating if
7537  *	trigger based ranging measurement is supported
7538  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED: flag attribute indicating
7539  *	if non-trigger-based ranging measurement is supported
7540  *
7541  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR: internal
7542  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7543  */
7544 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_capa {
7545 	__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_INVALID,
7546 
7547 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_ASAP,
7548 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_ASAP,
7549 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_LCI,
7550 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_CIVICLOC,
7551 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_PREAMBLES,
7552 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_BANDWIDTHS,
7553 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_BURSTS_EXPONENT,
7554 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_FTMS_PER_BURST,
7555 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED,
7556 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED,
7557 
7558 	/* keep last */
7559 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR,
7560 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR - 1
7561 };
7562 
7563 /**
7564  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_req - FTM request attributes
7565  * @__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7566  *
7567  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_ASAP: ASAP mode requested (flag)
7568  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_PREAMBLE: preamble type (see
7569  *	&enum nl80211_preamble), optional for DMG (u32)
7570  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP: number of bursts exponent as in
7571  *	802.11-2016 9.4.2.168 "Fine Timing Measurement Parameters element"
7572  *	(u8, 0-15, optional with default 15 i.e. "no preference")
7573  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_PERIOD: interval between bursts in units
7574  *	of 100ms (u16, optional with default 0)
7575  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_DURATION: burst duration, as in 802.11-2016
7576  *	Table 9-257 "Burst Duration field encoding" (u8, 0-15, optional with
7577  *	default 15 i.e. "no preference")
7578  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST: number of successful FTM frames
7579  *	requested per burst
7580  *	(u8, 0-31, optional with default 0 i.e. "no preference")
7581  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_RETRIES: number of FTMR frame retries
7582  *	(u8, default 3)
7583  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_LCI: request LCI data (flag)
7584  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_CIVICLOC: request civic location data
7585  *	(flag)
7586  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED: request trigger based ranging
7587  *	measurement (flag).
7588  *	This attribute and %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED are
7589  *	mutually exclusive.
7590  *      if neither %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED nor
7591  *	%NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED is set, EDCA based
7592  *	ranging will be used.
7593  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED: request non-trigger-based
7594  *	ranging measurement (flag)
7595  *	This attribute and %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED are
7596  *	mutually exclusive.
7597  *      if neither %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED nor
7598  *	%NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED is set, EDCA based
7599  *	ranging will be used.
7600  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_LMR_FEEDBACK: negotiate for LMR feedback. Only
7601  *	valid if either %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED or
7602  *	%NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED is set.
7603  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BSS_COLOR: optional. The BSS color of the
7604  *	responder. Only valid if %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED
7605  *	or %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED is set.
7606  *
7607  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR: internal
7608  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7609  */
7610 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_req {
7611 	__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_INVALID,
7612 
7613 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_ASAP,
7614 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_PREAMBLE,
7615 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP,
7616 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_PERIOD,
7617 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_DURATION,
7618 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST,
7619 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_RETRIES,
7620 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_LCI,
7621 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_CIVICLOC,
7622 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED,
7623 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED,
7624 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_LMR_FEEDBACK,
7625 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BSS_COLOR,
7626 
7627 	/* keep last */
7628 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR,
7629 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR - 1
7630 };
7631 
7632 /**
7633  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons - FTM failure reasons
7634  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_UNSPECIFIED: unspecified failure, not used
7635  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_NO_RESPONSE: no response from the FTM responder
7636  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_REJECTED: FTM responder rejected measurement
7637  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_WRONG_CHANNEL: we already know the peer is
7638  *	on a different channel, so can't measure (if we didn't know, we'd
7639  *	try and get no response)
7640  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_NOT_CAPABLE: peer can't actually do FTM
7641  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_INVALID_TIMESTAMP: invalid T1/T4 timestamps
7642  *	received
7643  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY: peer reports busy, you may retry
7644  *	later (see %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BUSY_RETRY_TIME)
7645  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_BAD_CHANGED_PARAMS: parameters were changed
7646  *	by the peer and are no longer supported
7647  */
7648 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons {
7649 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_UNSPECIFIED,
7650 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_NO_RESPONSE,
7651 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_REJECTED,
7652 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_WRONG_CHANNEL,
7653 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_NOT_CAPABLE,
7654 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_INVALID_TIMESTAMP,
7655 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY,
7656 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_BAD_CHANGED_PARAMS,
7657 };
7658 
7659 /**
7660  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_resp - FTM response attributes
7661  * @__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7662  *
7663  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FAIL_REASON: FTM-specific failure reason
7664  *	(u32, optional)
7665  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_INDEX: optional, if bursts are reported
7666  *	as separate results then it will be the burst index 0...(N-1) and
7667  *	the top level will indicate partial results (u32)
7668  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_ATTEMPTS: number of FTM Request frames
7669  *	transmitted (u32, optional)
7670  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_SUCCESSES: number of FTM Request frames
7671  *	that were acknowledged (u32, optional)
7672  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BUSY_RETRY_TIME: retry time received from the
7673  *	busy peer (u32, seconds)
7674  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP: actual number of bursts exponent
7675  *	used by the responder (similar to request, u8)
7676  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_DURATION: actual burst duration used by
7677  *	the responder (similar to request, u8)
7678  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST: actual FTMs per burst used
7679  *	by the responder (similar to request, u8)
7680  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_AVG: average RSSI across all FTM action
7681  *	frames (optional, s32, 1/2 dBm)
7682  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_SPREAD: RSSI spread across all FTM action
7683  *	frames (optional, s32, 1/2 dBm)
7684  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_TX_RATE: bitrate we used for the response to the
7685  *	FTM action frame (optional, nested, using &enum nl80211_rate_info
7686  *	attributes)
7687  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RX_RATE: bitrate the responder used for the FTM
7688  *	action frame (optional, nested, using &enum nl80211_rate_info attrs)
7689  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_AVG: average RTT (s64, picoseconds, optional
7690  *	but one of RTT/DIST must be present)
7691  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_VARIANCE: RTT variance (u64, ps^2, note that
7692  *	standard deviation is the square root of variance, optional)
7693  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_SPREAD: RTT spread (u64, picoseconds,
7694  *	optional)
7695  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_AVG: average distance (s64, mm, optional
7696  *	but one of RTT/DIST must be present)
7697  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_VARIANCE: distance variance (u64, mm^2, note
7698  *	that standard deviation is the square root of variance, optional)
7699  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_SPREAD: distance spread (u64, mm, optional)
7700  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI: LCI data from peer (binary, optional);
7701  *	this is the contents of the Measurement Report Element (802.11-2016
7702  *	9.4.2.22.1) starting with the Measurement Token, with Measurement
7703  *	Type 8.
7704  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVICLOC: civic location data from peer
7705  *	(binary, optional);
7706  *	this is the contents of the Measurement Report Element (802.11-2016
7707  *	9.4.2.22.1) starting with the Measurement Token, with Measurement
7708  *	Type 11.
7709  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_PAD: ignore, for u64/s64 padding only
7710  *
7711  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR: internal
7712  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7713  */
7714 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_resp {
7715 	__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID,
7716 
7717 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FAIL_REASON,
7718 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_INDEX,
7719 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_ATTEMPTS,
7720 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_SUCCESSES,
7721 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BUSY_RETRY_TIME,
7722 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP,
7723 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_DURATION,
7724 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST,
7725 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_AVG,
7726 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_SPREAD,
7727 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_TX_RATE,
7728 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RX_RATE,
7729 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_AVG,
7730 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_VARIANCE,
7731 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_SPREAD,
7732 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_AVG,
7733 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_VARIANCE,
7734 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_SPREAD,
7735 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI,
7736 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVICLOC,
7737 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_PAD,
7738 
7739 	/* keep last */
7740 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR,
7741 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR - 1
7742 };
7743 
7744 /**
7745  * enum nl80211_obss_pd_attributes - OBSS packet detection attributes
7746  * @__NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7747  *
7748  * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MIN_OFFSET: the OBSS PD minimum tx power offset.
7749  * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX_OFFSET: the OBSS PD maximum tx power offset.
7750  * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_NON_SRG_MAX_OFFSET: the non-SRG OBSS PD maximum
7751  *	tx power offset.
7752  * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_BSS_COLOR_BITMAP: bitmap that indicates the BSS color
7753  *	values used by members of the SRG.
7754  * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_PARTIAL_BSSID_BITMAP: bitmap that indicates the partial
7755  *	BSSID values used by members of the SRG.
7756  * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_SR_CTRL: The SR Control field of SRP element.
7757  *
7758  * @__NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7759  * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX: highest OBSS PD attribute.
7760  */
7761 enum nl80211_obss_pd_attributes {
7762 	__NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_INVALID,
7763 
7764 	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MIN_OFFSET,
7765 	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX_OFFSET,
7766 	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_NON_SRG_MAX_OFFSET,
7767 	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_BSS_COLOR_BITMAP,
7768 	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_PARTIAL_BSSID_BITMAP,
7769 	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_SR_CTRL,
7770 
7771 	/* keep last */
7772 	__NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_LAST,
7773 	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_LAST - 1,
7774 };
7775 
7776 /**
7777  * enum nl80211_bss_color_attributes - BSS Color attributes
7778  * @__NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7779  *
7780  * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_COLOR: the current BSS Color.
7781  * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_DISABLED: is BSS coloring disabled.
7782  * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_PARTIAL: the AID equation to be used..
7783  *
7784  * @__NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7785  * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_MAX: highest BSS Color attribute.
7786  */
7787 enum nl80211_bss_color_attributes {
7788 	__NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_INVALID,
7789 
7790 	NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_COLOR,
7791 	NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_DISABLED,
7792 	NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_PARTIAL,
7793 
7794 	/* keep last */
7795 	__NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_LAST,
7796 	NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_LAST - 1,
7797 };
7798 
7799 /**
7800  * enum nl80211_iftype_akm_attributes - interface type AKM attributes
7801  * @__NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7802  *
7803  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_IFTYPES: nested attribute containing a flag
7804  *	attribute for each interface type that supports AKM suites specified in
7805  *	%NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_SUITES
7806  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_SUITES: an array of u32. Used to indicate supported
7807  *	AKM suites for the specified interface types.
7808  *
7809  * @__NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7810  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_MAX: highest interface type AKM attribute.
7811  */
7812 enum nl80211_iftype_akm_attributes {
7813 	__NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_INVALID,
7814 
7815 	NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_IFTYPES,
7816 	NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_SUITES,
7817 
7818 	/* keep last */
7819 	__NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_LAST,
7820 	NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_LAST - 1,
7821 };
7822 
7823 /**
7824  * enum nl80211_fils_discovery_attributes - FILS discovery configuration
7825  * from IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
7826  *
7827  * @__NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7828  *
7829  * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MIN: Minimum packet interval (u32, TU).
7830  *	Allowed range: 0..10000 (TU = Time Unit)
7831  * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MAX: Maximum packet interval (u32, TU).
7832  *	Allowed range: 0..10000 (TU = Time Unit). If set to 0, the feature is disabled.
7833  * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_TMPL: Template data for FILS discovery action
7834  *	frame including the headers.
7835  *
7836  * @__NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7837  * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute
7838  */
7839 enum nl80211_fils_discovery_attributes {
7840 	__NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INVALID,
7841 
7842 	NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MIN,
7843 	NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MAX,
7844 	NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_TMPL,
7845 
7846 	/* keep last */
7847 	__NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_LAST,
7848 	NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_LAST - 1
7849 };
7850 
7851 /*
7852  * FILS discovery template minimum length with action frame headers and
7853  * mandatory fields.
7854  */
7855 #define NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_TMPL_MIN_LEN 42
7856 
7857 /**
7858  * enum nl80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_attributes - Unsolicited broadcast probe
7859  *	response configuration. Applicable only in 6GHz.
7860  *
7861  * @__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7862  *
7863  * @NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INT: Maximum packet interval (u32, TU).
7864  *	Allowed range: 0..20 (TU = Time Unit). IEEE P802.11ax/D6.0
7865  *	26.17.2.3.2 (AP behavior for fast passive scanning). If set to 0, the feature is
7866  *	disabled.
7867  * @NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_TMPL: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
7868  *	frame template (binary).
7869  *
7870  * @__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7871  * @NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute
7872  */
7873 enum nl80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_attributes {
7874 	__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INVALID,
7875 
7876 	NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INT,
7877 	NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_TMPL,
7878 
7879 	/* keep last */
7880 	__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_LAST,
7881 	NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_MAX =
7882 		__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_LAST - 1
7883 };
7884 
7885 /**
7886  * enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism - The mechanism(s) allowed for SAE PWE
7887  *	derivation. Applicable only when WPA3-Personal SAE authentication is
7888  *	used.
7889  *
7890  * @NL80211_SAE_PWE_UNSPECIFIED: not specified, used internally to indicate that
7891  *	attribute is not present from userspace.
7892  * @NL80211_SAE_PWE_HUNT_AND_PECK: hunting-and-pecking loop only
7893  * @NL80211_SAE_PWE_HASH_TO_ELEMENT: hash-to-element only
7894  * @NL80211_SAE_PWE_BOTH: both hunting-and-pecking loop and hash-to-element
7895  *	can be used.
7896  */
7897 enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism {
7898 	NL80211_SAE_PWE_UNSPECIFIED,
7899 	NL80211_SAE_PWE_HUNT_AND_PECK,
7900 	NL80211_SAE_PWE_HASH_TO_ELEMENT,
7901 	NL80211_SAE_PWE_BOTH,
7902 };
7903 
7904 /**
7905  * enum nl80211_sar_type - type of SAR specs
7906  *
7907  * @NL80211_SAR_TYPE_POWER: power limitation specified in 0.25dBm unit
7908  *
7909  * @NUM_NL80211_SAR_TYPE: internal
7910  */
7911 enum nl80211_sar_type {
7912 	NL80211_SAR_TYPE_POWER,
7913 
7914 	/* add new type here */
7915 
7916 	/* Keep last */
7917 	NUM_NL80211_SAR_TYPE,
7918 };
7919 
7920 /**
7921  * enum nl80211_sar_attrs - Attributes for SAR spec
7922  *
7923  * @__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7924  *
7925  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_TYPE: the SAR type as defined in &enum nl80211_sar_type.
7926  *
7927  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS: Nested array of SAR power
7928  *	limit specifications. Each specification contains a set
7929  *	of %nl80211_sar_specs_attrs.
7930  *
7931  *	For SET operation, it contains array of %NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_POWER
7932  *	and %NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_RANGE_INDEX.
7933  *
7934  *	For sar_capa dump, it contains array of
7935  *	%NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_START_FREQ
7936  *	and %NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_END_FREQ.
7937  *
7938  * @__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7939  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_MAX: highest sar attribute
7940  *
7941  * These attributes are used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_SAR_SPEC
7942  */
7943 enum nl80211_sar_attrs {
7944 	__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_INVALID,
7945 
7946 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_TYPE,
7947 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS,
7948 
7949 	__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_LAST,
7950 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_SAR_ATTR_LAST - 1,
7951 };
7952 
7953 /**
7954  * enum nl80211_sar_specs_attrs - Attributes for SAR power limit specs
7955  *
7956  * @__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_INVALID: Invalid
7957  *
7958  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_POWER: Required (s32)value to specify the actual
7959  *	power limit value in units of 0.25 dBm if type is
7960  *	NL80211_SAR_TYPE_POWER. (i.e., a value of 44 represents 11 dBm).
7961  *	0 means userspace doesn't have SAR limitation on this associated range.
7962  *
7963  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_RANGE_INDEX: Required (u32) value to specify the
7964  *	index of exported freq range table and the associated power limitation
7965  *	is applied to this range.
7966  *
7967  *	Userspace isn't required to set all the ranges advertised by WLAN driver,
7968  *	and userspace can skip some certain ranges. These skipped ranges don't
7969  *	have SAR limitations, and they are same as setting the
7970  *	%NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_POWER to any unreasonable high value because any
7971  *	value higher than regulatory allowed value just means SAR power
7972  *	limitation is removed, but it's required to set at least one range.
7973  *	It's not allowed to set duplicated range in one SET operation.
7974  *
7975  *	Every SET operation overwrites previous SET operation.
7976  *
7977  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_START_FREQ: Required (u32) value to specify the start
7978  *	frequency of this range edge when registering SAR capability to wiphy.
7979  *	It's not a channel center frequency. The unit is kHz.
7980  *
7981  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_END_FREQ: Required (u32) value to specify the end
7982  *	frequency of this range edge when registering SAR capability to wiphy.
7983  *	It's not a channel center frequency. The unit is kHz.
7984  *
7985  * @__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_LAST: Internal
7986  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_MAX: highest sar specs attribute
7987  */
7988 enum nl80211_sar_specs_attrs {
7989 	__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_INVALID,
7990 
7991 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_POWER,
7992 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_RANGE_INDEX,
7993 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_START_FREQ,
7994 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_END_FREQ,
7995 
7996 	__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_LAST,
7997 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_MAX = __NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_LAST - 1,
7998 };
7999 
8000 /**
8001  * enum nl80211_mbssid_config_attributes - multiple BSSID (MBSSID) and enhanced
8002  * multi-BSSID advertisements (EMA) in AP mode.
8003  * Kernel uses some of these attributes to advertise driver's support for
8004  * MBSSID and EMA.
8005  * Remaining attributes should be used by the userspace to configure the
8006  * features.
8007  *
8008  * @__NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
8009  *
8010  * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX_INTERFACES: Used by the kernel to advertise
8011  *	the maximum number of MBSSID interfaces supported by the driver.
8012  *	Driver should indicate MBSSID support by setting
8013  *	wiphy->mbssid_max_interfaces to a value more than or equal to 2.
8014  *
8015  * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX_EMA_PROFILE_PERIODICITY: Used by the kernel
8016  *	to advertise the maximum profile periodicity supported by the driver
8017  *	if EMA is enabled. Driver should indicate EMA support to the userspace
8018  *	by setting wiphy->ema_max_profile_periodicity to
8019  *	a non-zero value.
8020  *
8021  * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_INDEX: Mandatory parameter to pass the index of
8022  *	this BSS (u8) in the multiple BSSID set.
8023  *	Value must be set to 0 for the transmitting interface and non-zero for
8024  *	all non-transmitting interfaces. The userspace will be responsible
8025  *	for using unique indices for the interfaces.
8026  *	Range: 0 to wiphy->mbssid_max_interfaces-1.
8027  *
8028  * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_IFINDEX: Mandatory parameter for
8029  *	a non-transmitted profile which provides the interface index (u32) of
8030  *	the transmitted profile. The value must match one of the interface
8031  *	indices advertised by the kernel. Optional if the interface being set up
8032  *	is the transmitting one, however, if provided then the value must match
8033  *	the interface index of the same.
8034  *
8035  * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_EMA: Flag used to enable EMA AP feature.
8036  *	Setting this flag is permitted only if the driver advertises EMA support
8037  *	by setting wiphy->ema_max_profile_periodicity to non-zero.
8038  *
8039  * @__NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_LAST: Internal
8040  * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute
8041  */
8042 enum nl80211_mbssid_config_attributes {
8043 	__NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_INVALID,
8044 
8045 	NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX_INTERFACES,
8046 	NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX_EMA_PROFILE_PERIODICITY,
8047 	NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_INDEX,
8048 	NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_IFINDEX,
8049 	NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_EMA,
8050 
8051 	/* keep last */
8052 	__NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_LAST,
8053 	NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_LAST - 1,
8054 };
8055 
8056 /**
8057  * enum nl80211_ap_settings_flags - AP settings flags
8058  *
8059  * @NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: AP supports external
8060  *	authentication.
8061  * @NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT: Userspace supports SA Query
8062  *	procedures offload to driver. If driver advertises
8063  *	%NL80211_AP_SME_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD in AP SME features, userspace shall
8064  *	ignore SA Query procedures and validations when this flag is set by
8065  *	userspace.
8066  */
8067 enum nl80211_ap_settings_flags {
8068 	NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT	= 1 << 0,
8069 	NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT	= 1 << 1,
8070 };
8071 
8072 /**
8073  * enum nl80211_wiphy_radio_attrs - wiphy radio attributes
8074  *
8075  * @__NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
8076  *
8077  * @NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_INDEX: Index of this radio (u32)
8078  * @NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE: Frequency range supported by this
8079  *	radio. Attribute may be present multiple times.
8080  * @NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATION: Supported interface
8081  *	combination for this radio. Attribute may be present multiple times
8082  *	and contains attributes defined in &enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs.
8083  * @NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_ANTENNA_MASK: bitmask (u32) of antennas
8084  *	connected to this radio.
8085  *
8086  * @__NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_LAST: Internal
8087  * @NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_MAX: Highest attribute
8088  */
8089 enum nl80211_wiphy_radio_attrs {
8090 	__NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_INVALID,
8091 
8092 	NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_INDEX,
8093 	NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE,
8094 	NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATION,
8095 	NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_ANTENNA_MASK,
8096 
8097 	/* keep last */
8098 	__NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_LAST,
8099 	NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_ATTR_LAST - 1,
8100 };
8101 
8102 /**
8103  * enum nl80211_wiphy_radio_freq_range - wiphy radio frequency range
8104  *
8105  * @__NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_FREQ_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
8106  *
8107  * @NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_FREQ_ATTR_START: Frequency range start (u32).
8108  *	The unit is kHz.
8109  * @NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_FREQ_ATTR_END: Frequency range end (u32).
8110  *	The unit is kHz.
8111  *
8112  * @__NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_FREQ_ATTR_LAST: Internal
8113  * @NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_FREQ_ATTR_MAX: Highest attribute
8114  */
8115 enum nl80211_wiphy_radio_freq_range {
8116 	__NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_FREQ_ATTR_INVALID,
8117 
8118 	NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_FREQ_ATTR_START,
8119 	NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_FREQ_ATTR_END,
8120 
8121 	__NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_FREQ_ATTR_LAST,
8122 	NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_FREQ_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_WIPHY_RADIO_FREQ_ATTR_LAST - 1,
8123 };
8124 
8125 #endif /* __LINUX_NL80211_H */
8126